Mercurial > vim
annotate runtime/doc/options.txt @ 17543:77c3f6428b6c v8.1.1769
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ac3150d385e6e3f3fe76642aac3cda954d30583f
Author: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
Date: Sun Jul 28 16:36:39 2019 +0200
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Problem: 'shellslash' is also used for completion.
Solution: Add the 'completeslash' option. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, closes https://github.com/vim/vim/issues/3612)
author | Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org> |
---|---|
date | Sun, 28 Jul 2019 16:45:05 +0200 |
parents | ca8e754bdd53 |
children | 2704c4e3e20a |
rev | line source |
---|---|
17433 | 1 *options.txt* For Vim version 8.1. Last change: 2019 Jul 18 |
7 | 2 |
3 | |
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar | |
5 | |
6 | |
7 Options *options* | |
8 | |
9 1. Setting options |set-option| | |
10 2. Automatically setting options |auto-setting| | |
11 3. Options summary |option-summary| | |
12 | |
10244
876fbdd84e52
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ec618c9feac4573b154510236ad8121c77d0eca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10218
diff
changeset
|
13 For an overview of options see quickref.txt |option-list|. |
7 | 14 |
15 Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to | |
16 achieve special effects. These options come in three forms: | |
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle* | |
18 number has a numeric value | |
19 string has a string value | |
20 | |
21 ============================================================================== | |
523 | 22 1. Setting options *set-option* *E764* |
7 | 23 |
24 *:se* *:set* | |
25 :se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value. | |
26 | |
27 :se[t] all Show all but terminal options. | |
28 | |
29 :se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the | |
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated | |
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal | |
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either... | |
33 | |
34 *E518* *E519* | |
35 :se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}. | |
36 | |
37 :se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on. | |
38 Number option: show value. | |
39 String option: show value. | |
40 | |
41 :se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off. | |
42 | |
2152 | 43 *:set-!* *:set-inv* |
7 | 44 :se[t] {option}! or |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
45 :se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. |
7 | 46 |
47 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim* | |
48 :se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
49 current value of 'compatible'. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
50 :se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
51 :se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. |
7 | 52 |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
53 :se[t] all& Set all options to their default value. The values of |
7051
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
54 these options are not changed: |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
55 all terminal options, starting with t_ |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
56 'columns' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
57 'cryptmethod' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
58 'encoding' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
59 'key' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
60 'lines' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
61 'term' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
62 'ttymouse' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
63 'ttytype' |
eff26a8620ce
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/88774fdd23f08355297bb8cda78856859051d3c7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
6949
diff
changeset
|
64 Warning: This may have a lot of side effects. |
7 | 65 |
66 *:set-args* *E487* *E521* | |
67 :se[t] {option}={value} or | |
68 :se[t] {option}:{value} | |
69 Set string or number option to {value}. | |
70 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal, | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
71 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0'). |
7 | 72 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by |
73 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is | |
74 set). See |cmdline-completion|. | |
75 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and | |
76 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value} | |
77 is not allowed. | |
78 See |option-backslash| for using white space and | |
79 backslashes in {value}. | |
80 | |
81 :se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=* | |
82 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the | |
83 {value} to a string option. When the option is a | |
84 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the | |
85 value was empty. | |
86 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags | |
557 | 87 are removed. When adding a flag that was already |
88 present the option value doesn't change. | |
809 | 89 Also see |:set-args| above. |
7 | 90 |
91 :se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=* | |
92 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend | |
93 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a | |
94 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the | |
95 value was empty. | |
96 Also see |:set-args| above. | |
97 | |
98 :se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=* | |
99 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove | |
100 the {value} from a string option, if it is there. | |
101 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there | |
102 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma | |
103 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option | |
104 becomes empty. | |
105 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be | |
106 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags | |
107 one by one to avoid problems. | |
108 Also see |:set-args| above. | |
109 | |
110 The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: > | |
111 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3 | |
112 If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given | |
113 and the following arguments will be ignored. | |
114 | |
115 *:set-verbose* | |
116 When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it | |
117 was last set. Example: > | |
118 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent? | |
14864 | 119 < shiftwidth=4 ~ |
120 Last set from modeline line 1 ~ | |
121 cindent ~ | |
122 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim line 30 ~ | |
1621 | 123 This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose |
124 set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument. | |
125 When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message. | |
7 | 126 When the option was set while executing a function, user command or |
127 autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported. | |
128 Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting | |
129 'compatible'. | |
1621 | 130 A few special texts: |
14864 | 131 Last set from modeline line 1 ~ |
1621 | 132 Option was set in a |modeline|. |
133 Last set from --cmd argument ~ | |
134 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +. | |
135 Last set from -c argument ~ | |
136 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or | |
137 |-q|. | |
138 Last set from environment variable ~ | |
139 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT, | |
140 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT. | |
141 Last set from error handler ~ | |
142 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error. | |
143 | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
144 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature} |
7 | 145 |
146 *:set-termcap* *E522* | |
667 | 147 For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will |
7 | 148 override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If |
149 the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: > | |
150 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot | |
151 This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For | |
152 example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: > | |
153 :set <M-b>=^[b | |
154 (the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it) | |
155 The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations. | |
156 | |
2726 | 157 You can define any key codes, e.g.: > |
158 :set t_xy=^[foo; | |
159 There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these | |
160 codes as you like: > | |
161 :map <t_xy> something | |
162 < *E846* | |
163 When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its | |
164 value will result in an error: > | |
165 :set t_kb= | |
166 :set t_kb | |
167 E846: Key code not set: t_kb | |
168 | |
36 | 169 The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
170 security reasons. | |
171 | |
7 | 172 The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put |
10 | 173 at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of |
7 | 174 "set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the |
175 |more-prompt|. | |
176 | |
177 *option-backslash* | |
178 To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a | |
179 backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this | |
180 means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded | |
181 down). | |
182 A few examples: > | |
183 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags" | |
184 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file" | |
185 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file" | |
186 | |
10 | 187 The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To |
188 include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the | |
7 | 189 'titlestring' option to "hi|there": > |
190 :set titlestring=hi\|there | |
191 This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": > | |
192 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there | |
193 | |
642 | 194 Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in |
195 the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring' | |
196 option to 'hi "there"': > | |
197 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\" | |
198 | |
10 | 199 For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More |
7 | 200 precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment |
201 variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not | |
202 removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma, | |
203 etc.) is used like explained above. | |
204 There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": > | |
205 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path" | |
206 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path" | |
207 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!) | |
208 For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes | |
209 are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be | |
10 | 210 halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a |
7 | 211 result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it. |
212 | |
213 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags* | |
214 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552* | |
215 Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an | |
216 option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: > | |
217 :set guioptions+=a | |
218 Remove a flag from an option like this: > | |
219 :set guioptions-=a | |
220 This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'. | |
10 | 221 Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has |
7 | 222 the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba" |
223 doesn't appear. | |
224 | |
225 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var* | |
22 | 226 Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the |
7 | 227 environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable |
228 name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name | |
229 are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may | |
230 follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is | |
231 appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: > | |
232 :set term=$TERM.new | |
233 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,. | |
234 When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set | |
235 opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing. | |
236 | |
237 | |
238 Handling of local options *local-options* | |
239 | |
240 Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
241 has its own copy of this option, thus each can have its own value. This |
7 | 242 allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set |
243 'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another. | |
244 | |
245 The following explains what happens to these local options in specific | |
246 situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses | |
247 the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user | |
248 expects is a bit complicated... | |
249 | |
250 When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus | |
251 right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same. | |
252 | |
253 When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since | |
254 the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer, | |
255 these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a | |
256 global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and | |
257 global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed, | |
258 thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer. | |
259 | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
260 When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the options from the window |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
261 that was last closed are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
262 window, the values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
263 last closed window where the buffer was edited last are used. |
7 | 264 |
265 It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer. | |
266 When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep | |
267 using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the | |
268 local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window | |
269 has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but | |
270 global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: > | |
271 :e one | |
272 :set list | |
273 :e two | |
274 Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list" | |
275 command you have also set the global value. > | |
276 :set nolist | |
277 :e one | |
278 :setlocal list | |
279 :e two | |
280 Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global | |
281 value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the | |
282 global value. Note that if you do this next: > | |
283 :e one | |
4358 | 284 You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one". |
285 The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also | |
286 happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is | |
287 wiped out |:bwipe|. | |
7 | 288 |
289 *:setl* *:setlocal* | |
290 :setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the | |
291 current buffer or window. Not all options have a | |
292 local value. If the option does not have a local | |
293 value the global value is set. | |
2413 | 294 With the "all" argument: display local values for all |
295 local options. | |
296 Without argument: Display local values for all local | |
297 options which are different from the default. | |
7 | 298 When displaying a specific local option, show the |
1621 | 299 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when |
300 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed | |
301 before the option name. | |
302 For a global option the global value is | |
7 | 303 shown (but that might change in the future). |
304 | |
809 | 305 :setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by |
306 copying the value. | |
307 | |
3281 | 308 :se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of |
309 {option}, so that the global value will be used. | |
7 | 310 |
311 *:setg* *:setglobal* | |
312 :setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local | |
313 option without changing the local value. | |
314 When displaying an option, the global value is shown. | |
2413 | 315 With the "all" argument: display global values for all |
316 local options. | |
317 Without argument: display global values for all local | |
318 options which are different from the default. | |
7 | 319 |
320 For buffer-local and window-local options: | |
321 Command global value local value ~ | |
322 :set option=value set set | |
323 :setlocal option=value - set | |
324 :setglobal option=value set - | |
325 :set option? - display | |
326 :setlocal option? - display | |
327 :setglobal option? display - | |
328 | |
329 | |
330 Global options with a local value *global-local* | |
331 | |
40 | 332 Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows. |
333 For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value. | |
334 You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then | |
335 use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global | |
336 value. | |
7 | 337 |
338 For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global | |
339 'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: > | |
340 :set makeprg=gmake | |
341 then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set | |
342 the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too. | |
343 However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use | |
1152 | 344 another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source |
10 | 345 files. You use this command: > |
7 | 346 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake |
347 You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: > | |
348 :setlocal makeprg= | |
15729 | 349 This only works for a string option. For a number or boolean option you need |
350 to use the "<" flag, like this: > | |
7 | 351 :setlocal autoread< |
15729 | 352 Note that for non-boolean and non-number options using "<" copies the global |
353 value to the local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value | |
354 (that matters when the global value changes later). You can also use: > | |
809 | 355 :set path< |
356 This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is | |
357 used. Thus it does the same as: > | |
358 :setlocal path= | |
7 | 359 Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using |
360 ":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then. | |
361 | |
362 | |
363 Setting the filetype | |
364 | |
11473 | 365 :setf[iletype] [FALLBACK] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype* |
7 | 366 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if |
367 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands. | |
368 This is short for: > | |
369 :if !did_filetype() | |
370 : setlocal filetype={filetype} | |
371 :endif | |
372 < This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid | |
373 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different | |
374 settings and syntax files to be loaded. | |
11473 | 375 |
376 When the optional FALLBACK argument is present, a | |
377 later :setfiletype command will override the | |
16023 | 378 'filetype'. This is to be used for filetype |
379 detections that are just a guess. |did_filetype()| | |
380 will return false after this command. | |
11473 | 381 |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
382 *option-window* *optwin* |
7 | 383 :bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options* |
384 :opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options. | |
385 Options are grouped by function. | |
386 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the | |
387 short help to open a help window with more help for | |
388 the option. | |
389 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the | |
390 "set" line to set the new value. For window and | |
391 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is | |
392 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help | |
393 window, in which case the window below help window is | |
394 used (skipping the option-window). | |
13437 | 395 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
396 feature} | |
7 | 397 |
398 *$HOME* | |
399 Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an | |
400 option and after a space or comma. | |
401 | |
402 On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory | |
403 of user "user". Example: > | |
404 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,. | |
405 | |
406 On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can | |
407 contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the | |
408 "gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'. | |
409 | |
12254 | 410 NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set" |
411 command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let". | |
412 | |
413 *$HOME-windows* | |
3224 | 414 On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then |
415 at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH. | |
12499 | 416 If $HOMEDRIVE is not set then $USERPROFILE is used. |
417 | |
418 This expanded value is not exported to the environment, this matters when | |
419 running an external command: > | |
420 :echo system('set | findstr ^HOME=') | |
421 and > | |
422 :echo luaeval('os.getenv("HOME")') | |
423 should echo nothing (an empty string) despite exists('$HOME') being true. | |
424 When setting $HOME to a non-empty string it will be exported to the | |
425 subprocesses. | |
3224 | 426 |
7 | 427 |
428 Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on | |
429 the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters. | |
430 | |
431 *:fix* *:fixdel* | |
432 :fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD': | |
433 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~ | |
434 CTRL-? CTRL-H | |
435 not CTRL-? CTRL-? | |
436 | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
437 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) |
7 | 438 |
439 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the | |
440 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in | |
441 your .vimrc: > | |
442 :fixdel | |
443 < This works no matter what the actual code for | |
444 backspace is. | |
445 | |
446 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can | |
447 use this: > | |
448 :if &term == "termname" | |
449 : set t_kb=^V<BS> | |
450 : fixdel | |
451 :endif | |
452 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key | |
10 | 453 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname" |
7 | 454 with your terminal name. |
455 | |
456 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not | |
457 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: > | |
458 :if &term == "termname" | |
459 : set t_kD=^V<Delete> | |
460 :endif | |
461 < Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key | |
462 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname" | |
463 with your terminal name. | |
464 | |
465 *Linux-backspace* | |
466 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key | |
467 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by | |
468 putting this line in your rc.local: > | |
469 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys | |
470 < | |
471 *NetBSD-backspace* | |
472 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce | |
473 the right code, try this: > | |
474 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace" | |
475 < If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: > | |
476 keysym 22 = BackSpace | |
477 < You need to restart for this to take effect. | |
478 | |
479 ============================================================================== | |
480 2. Automatically setting options *auto-setting* | |
481 | |
482 Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives | |
483 to set options automatically for one or more files: | |
484 | |
485 1. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See | |
486 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions, | |
487 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started. | |
488 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and | |
489 |:mksession|. | |
490 2. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed. | |
491 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and | |
492 many other things. See |autocommand|. | |
493 3. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a | |
494 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for | |
495 modelines. This is explained here. | |
496 | |
497 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520* | |
498 There are two forms of modelines. The first form: | |
5055 | 499 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options} |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
500 |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
501 [text] any text or empty |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
502 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>) |
5055 | 503 {vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:" |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
504 [white] optional white space |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
505 {options} a list of option settings, separated with white space |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
506 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
507 for a ":set" command (can be empty) |
7 | 508 |
5055 | 509 Examples: |
782 | 510 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~ |
5055 | 511 vim: tw=77 ~ |
7 | 512 |
513 The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi): | |
514 | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
515 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text] |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
516 |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
517 [text] any text or empty |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
518 {white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>) |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
519 {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:" |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
520 [white] optional white space |
5055 | 521 se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When |
522 "Vim" is used it must be "set". | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
523 {options} a list of options, separated with white space, which |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
524 is the argument for a ":set" command |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
525 : a colon |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
526 [text] any text or empty |
7 | 527 |
5055 | 528 Examples: |
782 | 529 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~ |
5055 | 530 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~ |
7 | 531 |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
532 The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
533 chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
534 "vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
535 version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this |
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
536 could be short for "example:"). |
7 | 537 |
538 *modeline-local* | |
539 The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the | |
11 | 540 buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global |
541 options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and | |
542 the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result | |
543 depends on which one was opened last. | |
7 | 544 |
23 | 545 When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options |
546 from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local | |
547 option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer | |
548 in another window. But window-local options will be set. | |
549 | |
7 | 550 *modeline-version* |
551 If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version | |
5024
7a2ffd685c0e
Update runtime files. Remove duplicate tags in help.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5008
diff
changeset
|
552 number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used: |
7 | 553 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later |
554 vim<{vers}: version before {vers} | |
555 vim={vers}: version {vers} | |
556 vim>{vers}: version after {vers} | |
6647 | 557 {vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor). |
558 For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0: | |
559 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~ | |
560 To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2: | |
561 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~ | |
7 | 562 There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":". |
563 | |
564 | |
565 The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option. | |
566 If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked. | |
567 | |
568 Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line | |
782 | 569 like: |
570 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~ | |
571 will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK: | |
572 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~ | |
7 | 573 |
574 If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped. | |
575 | |
576 If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The | |
782 | 577 backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example: |
578 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~ | |
7 | 579 This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the |
580 ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:". | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
581 *E992* |
7 | 582 No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody |
1111 | 583 might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
584 can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when the value is used |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
585 the |sandbox| is effective. Some options can only be set from the modeline |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
586 when 'modelineexpr' is set (the default is off). |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
587 |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
588 Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline causes trouble. E.g., |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
589 when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines are wrapped unexpectedly. |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
590 So disable modelines before editing untrusted text. The mail ftplugin does |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
591 this, for example. |
7 | 592 |
593 Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could | |
594 define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For | |
595 example: > | |
596 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif | |
597 And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing | |
598 "VAR". | |
599 | |
600 ============================================================================== | |
601 3. Options summary *option-summary* | |
602 | |
603 In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with | |
604 an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used. | |
605 | |
606 In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option" | |
607 is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used. | |
608 | |
609 For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is | |
610 used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when | |
611 'compatible' is set. | |
612 | |
613 Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that | |
10 | 614 are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a |
7 | 615 different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in |
616 one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view | |
617 at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain | |
618 file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example | |
619 the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C | |
620 program. | |
621 | |
622 global one option for all buffers and windows | |
623 local to window each window has its own copy of this option | |
624 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option | |
625 | |
626 When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window | |
627 are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the | |
628 buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the | |
629 'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for | |
630 buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is | |
10 | 631 first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer |
632 is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not | |
7 | 633 present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the |
634 buffer is created. | |
635 | |
519 | 636 Hidden options *hidden-options* |
637 | |
638 Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported | |
639 features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces | |
640 below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an | |
641 error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden | |
642 option though, it is not stored. | |
643 | |
644 To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: > | |
645 if exists('&foo') | |
646 This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really | |
647 supported use something like this: > | |
648 if exists('+foo') | |
649 < | |
7 | 650 *E355* |
651 A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|. | |
652 | |
653 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph* | |
654 'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise) | |
655 global | |
656 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
657 feature} | |
658 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The | |
659 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode | |
660 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_) | |
661 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26]. | |
662 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8. | |
663 See |rileft.txt|. | |
664 | |
665 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'* | |
666 'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off) | |
667 global | |
668 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
669 feature} | |
670 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to | |
671 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get | |
672 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See | |
673 'revins'. | |
674 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
675 | |
676 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'* | |
677 'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off) | |
678 global | |
679 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi| | |
680 feature} | |
15850
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
681 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See |
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
682 |farsi.txt|. |
7 | 683 |
684 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'* | |
685 'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single") | |
686 global | |
687 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding. | |
688 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class | |
689 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek | |
690 letters, Cyrillic letters). | |
691 | |
692 There are currently two possible values: | |
233 | 693 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is |
7 | 694 expected by most users. |
695 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters. | |
2492
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
696 *E834* *E835* |
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
697 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars' |
c945fdb34ce3
Disallow setting 'ambiwidth' to "double" when 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2490
diff
changeset
|
698 contains a character that would be double width. |
7 | 699 |
700 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for | |
701 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in | |
702 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro, | |
703 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets, | |
233 | 704 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also |
7 | 705 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text |
233 | 706 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or |
7 | 707 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font |
708 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.), | |
709 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived | |
710 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has | |
711 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP | |
712 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode | |
713 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11). | |
714 | |
4229 | 715 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is |
716 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the | |
12499 | 717 escape sequence to request cursor position report. The response can |
718 be found in |v:termu7resp|. | |
4229 | 719 |
7 | 720 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'* |
721 'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off) | |
722 global | |
723 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled | |
724 on Mac OS X} | |
725 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X | |
726 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts, | |
727 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays. | |
728 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set | |
729 to its default (empty string). | |
11160 | 730 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 731 |
732 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'* | |
733 'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off) | |
734 global | |
2152 | 735 {only available when compiled with it, use |
736 exists("+autochdir") to check} | |
438 | 737 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you |
738 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window. | |
739 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened | |
740 or selected. | |
819 | 741 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work. |
7 | 742 |
743 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'* | |
744 'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off) | |
745 local to window | |
746 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
747 feature} | |
748 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text. | |
749 Setting this option will: | |
750 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set. | |
751 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set. | |
752 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles | |
753 between typing English and Arabic key mapping. | |
754 - Set the 'delcombine' option | |
755 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text. | |
756 | |
757 Resetting this option will: | |
758 - Reset the 'rightleft' option. | |
759 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value). | |
760 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global | |
3557 | 761 option). |
11160 | 762 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 763 Also see |arabic.txt|. |
764 | |
765 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'* | |
766 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'* | |
767 'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on) | |
768 global | |
769 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
770 feature} | |
771 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character | |
772 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language | |
3893 | 773 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad |
7 | 774 one which encompasses: |
775 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location | |
776 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone). | |
777 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters | |
778 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
779 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
780 form. |
7 | 781 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for |
782 further details see |arabic.txt|. | |
11160 | 783 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 784 |
785 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'* | |
786 'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off) | |
787 local to buffer | |
788 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR> | |
789 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not | |
790 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type | |
1152 | 791 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor |
792 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included | |
793 in 'cpoptions'. | |
10 | 794 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you |
795 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first | |
796 line. | |
7 | 797 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in |
798 a different way. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
799 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
800 restored when 'paste' is reset. |
7 | 801 |
802 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'* | |
803 'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off) | |
804 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
805 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and | |
806 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again. | |
14298
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
807 When the file has been deleted this is not done, so you have the text |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
808 from before it was deleted. When it appears again then it is read. |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
809 |timestamp| |
7 | 810 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to |
811 using the global value: > | |
812 :set autoread< | |
813 < | |
814 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'* | |
815 'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off) | |
816 global | |
817 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each | |
818 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!, | |
864 | 819 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I, |
7 | 820 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file. |
821 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see | |
822 'autowriteall' for that. | |
14695 | 823 Some buffers will not be written, specifically when 'buftype' is |
14668 | 824 "nowrite", "nofile", "terminal" or "prompt". |
7 | 825 |
826 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'* | |
827 'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off) | |
828 global | |
829 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit", | |
830 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window. | |
831 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has | |
832 been set. | |
833 | |
834 *'background'* *'bg'* | |
2826 | 835 'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below) |
7 | 836 global |
837 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a | |
838 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that | |
839 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal. | |
840 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used. | |
841 This will not always be correct. | |
842 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim | |
843 what the background color looks like. For changing the background | |
844 color, see |:hi-normal|. | |
845 | |
846 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for | |
10 | 847 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not |
1621 | 848 change. *g:colors_name* |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
849 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set) |
7 | 850 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If |
851 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work. | |
852 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
853 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed. |
7 | 854 |
855 When setting 'background' to the default value with: > | |
856 :set background& | |
857 < Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly, | |
858 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value. | |
859 | |
12499 | 860 When the |t_RB| option is set, Vim will use it to request the background |
11442 | 861 color from the terminal. If the returned RGB value is dark/light and |
862 'background' is not dark/light, 'background' will be set and the | |
863 screen is redrawn. This may have side effects, make t_BG empty in | |
12499 | 864 your .vimrc if you suspect this problem. The response to |t_RB| can |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
865 be found in |v:termrbgresp|. |
11442 | 866 |
7 | 867 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be |
868 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects | |
869 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to | |
870 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read | |
871 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background | |
872 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by | |
873 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value | |
874 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on"). | |
2826 | 875 |
876 For MS-DOS, Windows and OS/2 the default is "dark". | |
877 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux", | |
878 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark | |
879 background. Otherwise the default is "light". | |
880 | |
12254 | 881 The |:terminal| command and the |term_start()| function use the |
882 'background' value to decide whether the terminal window will start | |
883 with a white or black background. | |
884 | |
7 | 885 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly |
886 depending on the terminal name. Example: > | |
887 :if &term == "pcterm" | |
888 : set background=dark | |
889 :endif | |
890 < When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups | |
891 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER | |
892 the setting of the 'background' option. | |
893 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file | |
894 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this | |
895 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be | |
896 done with ":syntax on". | |
897 | |
898 *'backspace'* *'bs'* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
899 'backspace' 'bs' string (default "", set to "indent,eol,start" |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
900 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 901 global |
902 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert | |
903 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows | |
904 a way to backspace over something: | |
905 value effect ~ | |
906 indent allow backspacing over autoindent | |
907 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines) | |
908 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U | |
909 stop once at the start of insert. | |
910 | |
911 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used. | |
912 | |
913 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier: | |
914 value effect ~ | |
915 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible) | |
916 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol" | |
917 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start" | |
918 | |
919 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want. | |
920 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. | |
921 | |
922 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'* | |
923 'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off) | |
924 global | |
925 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the | |
926 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the | |
927 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being | |
928 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is | |
929 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both | |
10 | 930 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the |
7 | 931 |backup-table| for more explanations. |
932 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway. | |
933 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the | |
934 oldest version of a file. | |
935 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
936 | |
937 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'* | |
938 'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto") | |
6243 | 939 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 940 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's |
941 done. This is a comma separated list of words. | |
942 | |
943 The main values are: | |
944 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one | |
945 "no" rename the file and write a new one | |
946 "auto" one of the previous, what works best | |
947 | |
948 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are: | |
949 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing | |
950 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing | |
951 | |
952 Making a copy and overwriting the original file: | |
953 - Takes extra time to copy the file. | |
954 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or | |
955 has a resource fork, all this is preserved. | |
956 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link, | |
957 not of the real file. | |
958 | |
959 Renaming the file and writing a new one: | |
960 + It's fast. | |
961 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new | |
962 file. | |
963 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link. | |
964 | |
965 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file | |
966 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and | |
1152 | 967 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a |
968 copy will be made. | |
7 | 969 |
970 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in | |
971 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they | |
972 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing | |
973 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to | |
974 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be | |
975 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or | |
976 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not | |
977 be propagated back to the original source. | |
978 *crontab* | |
979 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program | |
980 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if | |
981 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the | |
10 | 982 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an |
7 | 983 example. |
984 | |
985 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled | |
986 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and | |
987 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file | |
10 | 988 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The |
7 | 989 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this |
990 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for | |
991 others. | |
992 | |
993 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has | |
994 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file | |
995 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic) | |
996 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't | |
997 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly | |
998 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but | |
999 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will | |
1000 again not rename the file. | |
1001 | |
11160 | 1002 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
1003 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
1004 | |
7 | 1005 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'* |
1006 'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:", | |
5555 | 1007 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp" |
7 | 1008 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/") |
1009 global | |
1010 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas. | |
1011 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1012 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1013 create it for you. |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
1014 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is |
7 | 1015 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this. |
1016 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory | |
1017 as the edited file. | |
33 | 1018 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to |
7 | 1019 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The |
1020 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file. | |
1021 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning). | |
1022 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part | |
1023 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory | |
1024 name, precede it with a backslash. | |
1025 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash. | |
1026 - A directory name may end in an '/'. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1027 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//", |
15033 | 1028 the backup file name will be built from the complete path to the |
1029 file with all path separators changed to percent '%' signs. This | |
1030 will ensure file name uniqueness in the backup directory. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1031 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1032 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1033 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
1034 use '//', instead of '\\'. |
7 | 1035 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
1036 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to | |
1037 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: > | |
1038 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces | |
1039 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start | |
1040 of the option is removed. | |
1041 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options. | |
1042 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: > | |
1043 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp | |
1044 < You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your | |
1045 home directory for this to work properly. | |
1046 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
1047 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
1048 uses another default. | |
1049 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1050 security reasons. | |
1051 | |
1052 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589* | |
1053 'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_") | |
1054 global | |
1055 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the | |
1056 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids | |
1057 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might | |
1058 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with | |
1059 ".bak" that you want to keep. | |
36 | 1060 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 1061 |
26 | 1062 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre |
1063 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to | |
1064 include a timestamp. > | |
1065 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~' | |
1066 < Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory. | |
1067 | |
7 | 1068 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'* |
13664
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1069 'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*" |
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1070 Unix: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*" |
f64c5e636c9f
patch 8.0.1704: 'backupskip' default doesn't work for Mac
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13482
diff
changeset
|
1071 Mac: "/private/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*") |
7 | 1072 global |
1073 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
1074 feature} | |
1075 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the | |
1076 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both | |
1077 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used. | |
1078 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|. | |
1079 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|. | |
1080 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the | |
233 | 1081 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix. |
1152 | 1082 |
3513 | 1083 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write |
1084 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you | |
1085 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable | |
1086 backups if you don't care about losing the file. | |
1087 | |
1152 | 1088 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use |
1089 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: > | |
8835
c1a5623cfc86
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/7c1c6dbb6817640fd3956a0d5417da23fde336d8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8748
diff
changeset
|
1090 :let &backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*' |
1152 | 1091 |
1092 < Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a | |
557 | 1093 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see |
1094 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|. | |
7 | 1095 |
1096 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'* | |
1097 'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600) | |
1098 global | |
1099 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
1100 feature} | |
1101 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|. | |
1102 | |
1103 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'* | |
1104 'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off) | |
1105 global | |
1106 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| | |
189 | 1107 feature} |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1108 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the GUI. |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1109 |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1110 *'balloonevalterm'* *'bevalterm'* *'noballoonevalterm'* |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1111 *'nobevalterm'* |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1112 'balloonevalterm' 'bevalterm' boolean (default off) |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1113 global |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1114 {only available when compiled with the |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1115 |+balloon_eval_term| feature} |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
1116 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the terminal. |
7 | 1117 |
189 | 1118 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'* |
1119 'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "") | |
790 | 1120 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
189 | 1121 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval| |
1122 feature} | |
782 | 1123 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used |
16610 | 1124 when 'ballooneval' or 'balloonevalterm' is on. These variables can be |
1125 used: | |
189 | 1126 |
1127 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show | |
1128 v:beval_winnr number of the window | |
9227
ecb621205ed1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/82af8710bf8d1caeeceafb1370a052cb7d92f076
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9116
diff
changeset
|
1129 v:beval_winid ID of the window |
189 | 1130 v:beval_lnum line number |
1131 v:beval_col column number (byte index) | |
1132 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer | |
1133 | |
1134 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! | |
1135 Example: > | |
16610 | 1136 function MyBalloonExpr() |
435 | 1137 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum . |
189 | 1138 \', column ' . v:beval_col . |
1139 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) . | |
1140 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"' | |
1141 endfunction | |
1142 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr() | |
1143 set ballooneval | |
1144 < | |
17372 | 1145 Also see |balloon_show()|, it can be used if the content of the balloon |
1146 is to be fetched asynchronously. In that case evaluating | |
1147 'balloonexpr' should result in an empty string. If you get a balloon | |
1148 with only "0" you probably didn't return anything from your function. | |
11062 | 1149 |
189 | 1150 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text |
1151 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty, | |
1152 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans | |
1153 or Sun Workshop). | |
1154 | |
3682 | 1155 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
1156 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
1157 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 1158 |
1159 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
17372 | 1160 evaluating 'balloonexpr', see |textlock|. |
634 | 1161 |
446 | 1162 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: > |
435 | 1163 if has("balloon_multiline") |
714 | 1164 < When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the |
1165 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item | |
1166 as a string and putting "\n" in between them. | |
11160 | 1167 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
714 | 1168 |
6949 | 1169 *'belloff'* *'bo'* |
1170 'belloff' 'bo' string (default "") | |
1171 global | |
1172 Specifies for which events the bell will not be rung. It is a comma | |
1173 separated list of items. For each item that is present, the bell | |
1174 will be silenced. This is most useful to specify specific events in | |
1175 insert mode to be silenced. | |
1176 | |
1177 item meaning when present ~ | |
1178 all All events. | |
1179 backspace When hitting <BS> or <Del> and deleting results in an | |
1180 error. | |
1181 cursor Fail to move around using the cursor keys or | |
1182 <PageUp>/<PageDown> in |Insert-mode|. | |
1183 complete Error occurred when using |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K| or | |
1184 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. | |
1185 copy Cannot copy char from insert mode using |i_CTRL-Y| or | |
1186 |i_CTRL-E|. | |
1187 ctrlg Unknown Char after <C-G> in Insert mode. | |
1188 error Other Error occurred (e.g. try to join last line) | |
1189 (mostly used in |Normal-mode| or |Cmdline-mode|). | |
1190 esc hitting <Esc> in |Normal-mode|. | |
1191 ex In |Visual-mode|, hitting |Q| results in an error. | |
1192 hangul Error occurred when using hangul input. | |
1193 insertmode Pressing <Esc> in 'insertmode'. | |
1194 lang Calling the beep module for Lua/Mzscheme/TCL. | |
1195 mess No output available for |g<|. | |
1196 showmatch Error occurred for 'showmatch' function. | |
1197 operator Empty region error |cpo-E|. | |
1198 register Unknown register after <C-R> in |Insert-mode|. | |
1199 shell Bell from shell output |:!|. | |
1200 spell Error happened on spell suggest. | |
1201 wildmode More matches in |cmdline-completion| available | |
1202 (depends on the 'wildmode' setting). | |
1203 | |
11160 | 1204 This is most useful to fine tune when in Insert mode the bell should |
1205 be rung. For Normal mode and Ex commands, the bell is often rung to | |
6949 | 1206 indicate that an error occurred. It can be silenced by adding the |
1207 "error" keyword. | |
1208 | |
7 | 1209 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'* |
1210 'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off) | |
1211 local to buffer | |
1212 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also | |
1213 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few | |
1214 options will be changed (also when it already was on): | |
1215 'textwidth' will be set to 0 | |
1216 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0 | |
1217 'modeline' will be off | |
1218 'expandtab' will be off | |
1219 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the | |
1220 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL> | |
1221 separates lines). | |
1222 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the | |
1223 file is read without conversion. | |
1224 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is | |
1225 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g., | |
1226 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set | |
1227 'bin' again when the file has been loaded. | |
1228 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when | |
1229 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of | |
1230 saved option values. | |
1231 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument. | |
1232 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all | |
1233 files you edit. | |
1234 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if | |
1235 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to | |
1236 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See | |
1237 the 'endofline' option. | |
1238 | |
1239 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'* | |
1240 'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on) | |
1241 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
1242 {only for MS-DOS} |
8246
f16bfe02cef1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f391327adbbffb11180cf6038a92af1ed144e907
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8182
diff
changeset
|
1243 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported. |
7 | 1244 |
1245 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'* | |
1246 'bomb' boolean (default off) | |
1247 local to buffer | |
1248 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte | |
1249 Order Mark) is prepended to the file: | |
1250 - this option is on | |
1251 - the 'binary' option is off | |
1252 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big | |
1253 endian variants. | |
1254 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file. | |
1255 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it | |
1256 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
1257 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM. |
7 | 1258 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a |
1259 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly. | |
1260 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you | |
1261 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM | |
1262 will be restored when writing the file. | |
1263 | |
1264 *'breakat'* *'brk'* | |
1265 'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?") | |
1266 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1267 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 1268 feature} |
1269 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line | |
500 | 1270 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit |
1271 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding. | |
7 | 1272 |
8835
c1a5623cfc86
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/7c1c6dbb6817640fd3956a0d5417da23fde336d8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8748
diff
changeset
|
1273 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* *'nobreakindent'* *'nobri'* |
6009 | 1274 'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off) |
1275 local to window | |
1276 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| | |
1277 feature} | |
1278 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of | |
1279 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks | |
1280 of text. | |
11160 | 1281 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
6009 | 1282 |
1283 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'* | |
1284 'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty) | |
1285 local to window | |
1286 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| | |
1287 feature} | |
1288 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional | |
6026 | 1289 items and must be separated by a comma: |
6009 | 1290 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after |
1291 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting | |
1292 text should normally be narrower. This prevents | |
1293 text indented almost to the right window border | |
1294 occupying lot of vertical space when broken. | |
6026 | 1295 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's |
1296 beginning will be shifted by the given number of | |
1297 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph | |
6009 | 1298 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line |
1299 continuation (positive). | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
1300 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the |
6009 | 1301 additional indent. |
1302 The default value for min is 20 and shift is 0. | |
1303 | |
7 | 1304 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'* |
29 | 1305 'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last") |
7 | 1306 global |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
1307 {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and Win32 GUI} |
7 | 1308 Which directory to use for the file browser: |
1621 | 1309 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
1310 file was opened or saved. |
7 | 1311 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer. |
1312 current Use the current directory. | |
1313 {path} Use the specified directory | |
1314 | |
1315 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'* | |
1316 'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "") | |
1317 local to buffer | |
1318 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer | |
1319 displayed in a window: | |
1320 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option | |
1321 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden' | |
1322 is not set | |
1323 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using | |
1324 |:hide| | |
1325 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when | |
1326 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using | |
1327 |:bdelete| | |
1328 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when | |
1329 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using | |
1330 |:bwipeout| | |
1331 | |
82 | 1332 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer |
3224 | 1333 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands |
1334 that switch between buffers temporarily. | |
7 | 1335 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify |
1336 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
1337 | |
1338 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85* | |
1339 'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on) | |
1340 local to buffer | |
1341 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If | |
1342 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc. | |
1343 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember | |
1344 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer. | |
1345 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer". | |
1346 | |
1347 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382* | |
1348 'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "") | |
1349 local to buffer | |
1350 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer: | |
1351 <empty> normal buffer | |
1352 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be | |
1353 written | |
1354 nowrite buffer which will not be written | |
17 | 1355 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd |
13437 | 1356 autocommands. |
7 | 1357 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow| |
648 | 1358 or list of locations |:lwindow| |
7 | 1359 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this |
1360 manually) | |
11757
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
1361 terminal buffer for a |terminal| (you are not supposed to set |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
1362 this manually) |
14019
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1363 prompt buffer where only the last line can be edited, meant |
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1364 to be used by a plugin, see |prompt-buffer| |
dc67449d648c
patch 8.1.0027: difficult to make a plugin that feeds a line to a job
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14006
diff
changeset
|
1365 {only when compiled with the |+channel| feature} |
16778
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
1366 popup buffer used in a popup window, see |popup|. |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
1367 {only when compiled with the |+textprop| feature} |
7 | 1368 |
1369 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to | |
1370 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
1371 | |
1372 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects! | |
1373 | |
648 | 1374 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location |
1375 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and | |
1376 you are not supposed to change it. | |
7 | 1377 |
1378 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar: | |
1379 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't | |
1380 work (":w filename" does work though). | |
1381 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|. | |
1382 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for | |
1383 example when you quit Vim. | |
1384 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory | |
1385 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap | |
1386 file). | |
1387 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a | |
1388 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd| | |
1389 command. | |
6647 | 1390 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname" |
1391 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are | |
1392 triggered as usual for |:edit|. | |
17 | 1393 *E676* |
1394 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like | |
1395 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and | |
1396 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned | |
1397 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|, | |
1398 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands. | |
7 | 1399 |
1400 *'casemap'* *'cmp'* | |
1401 'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii") | |
1402 global | |
1403 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain | |
1404 these words, separated by a comma: | |
1405 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current | |
1406 locale does not change the case mapping. This only | |
493 | 1407 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding, |
1408 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is | |
1409 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library | |
1410 functions are used when available. | |
7 | 1411 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US |
1412 case mapping, the current locale is not effective. | |
1413 This probably only matters for Turkish. | |
1414 | |
1415 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346* | |
1416 'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,") | |
1417 global | |
1418 {not available when compiled without the | |
1419 |+file_in_path| feature} | |
1420 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the | |
16427
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1421 |:cd|, |:tcd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being |
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1422 searched for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with |
8c3a1bd270bb
patch 8.1.1218: cannot set a directory for a tab page
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16380
diff
changeset
|
1423 "/", "./" or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then. |
7 | 1424 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as |
1425 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|. | |
1426 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look | |
1427 in the current directory first. | |
1428 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include | |
1429 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to | |
1430 override it: > | |
1431 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g') | |
1432 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1433 security reasons. | |
1434 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names). | |
1435 | |
1436 *'cedit'* | |
1437 'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F) | |
1438 global | |
1439 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| | |
1440 feature} | |
1441 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window. | |
1442 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off. | |
1443 Only non-printable keys are allowed. | |
1444 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to | |
1445 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: > | |
9407
619a98a67f67
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18dbe865d190e74fb5d43ac8bc6ac22507d0223
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9344
diff
changeset
|
1446 :exe "set cedit=\<C-Y>" |
619a98a67f67
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e18dbe865d190e74fb5d43ac8bc6ac22507d0223
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9344
diff
changeset
|
1447 :exe "set cedit=\<Esc>" |
7 | 1448 < |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character. |
1449 See |cmdwin|. | |
11160 | 1450 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
1451 is reset. | |
7 | 1452 |
1453 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513* | |
1454 'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "") | |
1455 global | |
15878 | 1456 {only available when compiled with the |+eval| feature} |
7 | 1457 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is |
1458 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a | |
1459 different encoding from what is desired. | |
1460 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is | |
1461 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is | |
1462 preferred, because it is much faster. | |
1463 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no | |
1464 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first. | |
1465 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success, | |
1466 non-zero for failure. | |
1467 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'. | |
1468 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are | |
1469 used. | |
1470 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8" | |
1471 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this. | |
1472 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c' | |
1473 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion. | |
1474 Example: > | |
1475 set charconvert=CharConvert() | |
1476 fun CharConvert() | |
1477 system("recode " | |
1478 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to | |
1479 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out) | |
1480 return v:shell_error | |
1481 endfun | |
1482 < The related Vim variables are: | |
1483 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding | |
1484 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding | |
1485 v:fname_in name of the input file | |
1486 v:fname_out name of the output file | |
1487 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same. | |
1488 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different | |
1489 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4. | |
1490 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want | |
1491 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care | |
1492 of this. | |
1493 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
1494 security reasons. | |
1495 | |
1496 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'* | |
1497 'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off) | |
1498 local to buffer | |
1499 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1500 feature} | |
1621 | 1501 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys |
7 | 1502 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your |
1503 preferred indent style. | |
1504 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'. | |
1505 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty, | |
1506 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an | |
1507 external program. | |
1508 See |C-indenting|. | |
1509 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent' | |
1510 option or 'indentexpr'. | |
1511 This option is not used when 'paste' is set. | |
1512 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
1513 | |
1514 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'* | |
15701
9cd11f6beb70
patch 8.1.0858: 'indentkeys' and 'cinkeys' defaults are different
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15512
diff
changeset
|
1515 'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e") |
7 | 1516 local to buffer |
1517 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1518 feature} | |
1519 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of | |
1520 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is | |
1521 empty. | |
1522 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|. | |
1523 See |C-indenting|. | |
1524 | |
1525 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'* | |
1526 'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "") | |
1527 local to buffer | |
1528 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
1529 feature} | |
1530 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C | |
1531 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and | |
1532 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general. | |
1533 | |
1534 | |
1535 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'* | |
1536 'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch") | |
1537 local to buffer | |
1538 {not available when compiled without both the | |
1539 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features} | |
1540 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when | |
1541 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at | |
1542 an appropriate place (inside {}). | |
1543 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't | |
1544 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase: | |
1545 "if,If,IF". | |
1546 | |
1547 *'clipboard'* *'cb'* | |
1548 'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux" | |
1549 for X-windows, "" otherwise) | |
1550 global | |
1551 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard| | |
1552 feature is included} | |
1553 This option is a list of comma separated names. | |
1554 These names are recognized: | |
1555 | |
3674 | 1556 *clipboard-unnamed* |
7 | 1557 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*' |
1558 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which | |
1559 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a | |
1560 register is explicitly specified, it will always be | |
1561 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard' | |
1562 or not. The clipboard register can always be | |
1563 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see | |
1564 |gui-clipboard|. | |
1565 | |
3682 | 1566 *clipboard-unnamedplus* |
4119 | 1567 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the |
1568 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of | |
1569 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put | |
1570 operations which would normally go to the unnamed | |
1571 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the | |
1572 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or | |
1573 put) will additionally copy the text into register | |
1574 '*'. | |
2662 | 1575 Only available with the |+X11| feature. |
2654 | 1576 Availability can be checked with: > |
1577 if has('unnamedplus') | |
1578 < | |
3682 | 1579 *clipboard-autoselect* |
7 | 1580 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present, |
1581 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual | |
1582 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the | |
1583 windowing system's global selection or put the | |
1584 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection | |
14999 | 1585 register "*. See |'go-a'| and |quotestar| for details. |
1586 When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in 'guioptions' | |
1587 is used, when the GUI is not active, this "autoselect" | |
1588 flag is used. | |
7 | 1589 Also applies to the modeless selection. |
1590 | |
3674 | 1591 *clipboard-autoselectplus* |
1592 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of | |
1593 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in | |
1594 'guioptions'. | |
1595 | |
1596 *clipboard-autoselectml* | |
7 | 1597 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection |
1598 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'. | |
1599 | |
3674 | 1600 *clipboard-html* |
1904 | 1601 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when |
1602 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it | |
1603 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from | |
1604 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML | |
1605 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox. | |
2240
6b4879aea261
Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
1606 You probably want to add this only temporarily, |
6b4879aea261
Add test for gettabvar() and settabvar().
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
1607 possibly use BufEnter autocommands. |
1904 | 1608 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later. |
1609 | |
3674 | 1610 *clipboard-exclude* |
7 | 1611 exclude:{pattern} |
1612 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of | |
1613 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no | |
1614 connection will be made to the X server. This is | |
1615 useful in this situation: | |
1616 - Running Vim in a console. | |
1617 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another | |
1618 display. | |
1619 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the | |
1620 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator. | |
1621 To never connect to the X server use: > | |
1622 exclude:.* | |
1623 < This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument. | |
1624 Note that when there is no connection to the X server | |
1625 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard | |
1626 cannot be accessed. | |
1627 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is | |
1628 interpreted as if 'magic' was on. | |
1629 The rest of the option value will be used for | |
1630 {pattern}, this must be the last entry. | |
1631 | |
1632 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'* | |
1633 'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1) | |
1634 global | |
1635 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding | |
1636 |hit-enter| prompts. | |
824 | 1637 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab |
1638 page can have a different value. | |
7 | 1639 |
1640 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'* | |
1641 'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7) | |
1642 global | |
1643 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| | |
1644 feature} | |
1645 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin| | |
1646 | |
2608
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1647 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'* |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1648 'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "") |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1649 local to window |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1650 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1651 feature} |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1652 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1653 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1654 text. Will make screen redrawing slower. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1655 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1656 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. > |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1657 |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1658 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth' |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1659 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth' |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1660 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1661 < |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1662 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1663 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted. |
7d8af31066c8
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2607
diff
changeset
|
1664 |
7 | 1665 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594* |
1666 'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width) | |
1667 global | |
1668 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal | |
161 | 1669 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see |
1670 |posix-screen-size|. | |
7 | 1671 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this |
1672 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want | |
1673 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file. | |
1674 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical | |
1152 | 1675 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For |
1676 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to | |
1677 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest | |
1678 window possible: > | |
1679 :set columns=9999 | |
1680 < Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000. | |
7 | 1681 |
1682 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525* | |
1683 'comments' 'com' string (default | |
1684 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-") | |
1685 local to buffer | |
1686 {not available when compiled without the |+comments| | |
1687 feature} | |
1688 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See | |
1689 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to | |
1690 insert a space. | |
1691 | |
1692 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537* | |
1693 'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/") | |
1694 local to buffer | |
1695 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
1696 feature} | |
1697 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the | |
1698 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see | |
1699 |fold-marker|. | |
1700 | |
1701 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'* | |
819 | 1702 'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
1703 file is found, reset in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 1704 global |
1705 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or | |
1706 make Vim behave in a more useful way. | |
11062 | 1707 |
7 | 1708 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset, |
11062 | 1709 other options are also changed as a side effect. |
1710 NOTE: Setting or resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected | |
1711 effects: Mappings are interpreted in another way, undo behaves | |
1712 differently, etc. If you set this option in your vimrc file, you | |
1713 should probably put it at the very start. | |
1714 | |
7 | 1715 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the |
1716 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim | |
1717 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible' | |
1718 option. | |
819 | 1719 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up, |
378 | 1720 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been |
1721 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means | |
819 | 1722 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim |
378 | 1723 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't |
1152 | 1724 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given |
1725 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and | |
1726 |posix-compliance|. | |
7 | 1727 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with |
1728 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|. | |
11062 | 1729 See 'cpoptions' for more fine tuning of Vi compatibility. |
1730 | |
1731 When this option is set, numerous other options are set to make Vim as | |
1732 Vi-compatible as possible. When this option is unset, various options | |
1733 are set to make Vim more useful. The table below lists all the | |
1734 options affected. | |
1735 The {?} column indicates when the options are affected: | |
1736 + Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when | |
1737 'compatible' is set. | |
1738 & Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when | |
1739 'compatible' is set AND is set to its Vim default value when | |
1740 'compatible' is unset. | |
1741 - Means the option is NOT changed when setting 'compatible' but IS | |
1742 set to its Vim default when 'compatible' is unset. | |
1743 The {effect} column summarises the change when 'compatible' is set. | |
1744 | |
11160 | 1745 option ? set value effect ~ |
11062 | 1746 |
1747 'allowrevins' + off no CTRL-_ command | |
1748 'antialias' + off don't use antialiased fonts | |
1749 'arabic' + off reset arabic-related options | |
1750 'arabicshape' + on correct character shapes | |
1751 'backspace' + "" normal backspace | |
1752 'backup' + off no backup file | |
1753 'backupcopy' & Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy | |
1754 else: "auto" copy or rename backup file | |
1755 'balloonexpr' + "" text to show in evaluation balloon | |
1756 'breakindent' + off don't indent when wrapping lines | |
1757 'cedit' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1758 'cindent' + off no C code indentation | |
1759 'compatible' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1760 'copyindent' + off don't copy indent structure | |
1761 'cpoptions' & (all flags) Vi-compatible flags | |
1762 'cscopepathcomp'+ 0 don't show directories in tags list | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
1763 'cscoperelative'+ off don't use basename of path as prefix |
11062 | 1764 'cscopetag' + off don't use cscope for ":tag" |
11160 | 1765 'cscopetagorder'+ 0 see |cscopetagorder| |
11062 | 1766 'cscopeverbose' + off see |cscopeverbose| |
1767 'delcombine' + off unicode: delete whole char combination | |
1768 'digraph' + off no digraphs | |
1769 'esckeys' & off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode | |
1770 'expandtab' + off tabs not expanded to spaces | |
1771 'fileformats' & "" no automatic file format detection, | |
7 | 1772 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2 |
11062 | 1773 'formatexpr' + "" use 'formatprg' for auto-formatting |
1774 'formatoptions' & "vt" Vi compatible formatting | |
1775 'gdefault' + off no default 'g' flag for ":s" | |
1776 'history' & 0 no commandline history | |
1777 'hkmap' + off no Hebrew keyboard mapping | |
1778 'hkmapp' + off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping | |
1779 'hlsearch' + off no highlighting of search matches | |
1780 'incsearch' + off no incremental searching | |
1781 'indentexpr' + "" no indenting by expression | |
1782 'insertmode' + off do not start in Insert mode | |
1783 'iskeyword' & "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric | |
7 | 1784 characters and '_' |
11062 | 1785 'joinspaces' + on insert 2 spaces after period |
1786 'modeline' & off no modelines | |
1787 'more' & off no pauses in listings | |
1788 'mzquantum' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1789 'numberwidth' & 8 min number of columns for line number | |
1790 'preserveindent'+ off don't preserve current indent structure | |
1791 when changing it | |
1792 'revins' + off no reverse insert | |
1793 'ruler' + off no ruler | |
1794 'scrolljump' + 1 no jump scroll | |
1795 'scrolloff' + 0 no scroll offset | |
1796 'shelltemp' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'} | |
1797 'shiftround' + off indent not rounded to shiftwidth | |
16533
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
1798 'shortmess' & "S" no shortening of messages |
11062 | 1799 'showcmd' & off command characters not shown |
1800 'showmode' & off current mode not shown | |
1801 'sidescrolloff' + 0 cursor moves to edge of screen in scroll | |
1802 'smartcase' + off no automatic ignore case switch | |
1803 'smartindent' + off no smart indentation | |
1804 'smarttab' + off no smart tab size | |
1805 'softtabstop' + 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions | |
1806 'startofline' + on goto startofline with some commands | |
1807 'tagcase' & "followic" 'ignorecase' when searching tags file | |
1808 'tagrelative' & off tag file names are not relative | |
1809 'termguicolors' + off don't use highlight-(guifg|guibg) | |
1810 'textauto' & off no automatic textmode detection | |
1811 'textwidth' + 0 no automatic line wrap | |
1812 'tildeop' + off tilde is not an operator | |
1813 'ttimeout' + off no terminal timeout | |
1814 'undofile' + off don't use an undo file | |
11160 | 1815 'viminfo' - {unchanged} {set Vim default only on resetting 'cp'} |
11062 | 1816 'virtualedit' + "" cursor can only be placed on characters |
1817 'whichwrap' & "" left-right movements don't wrap | |
1818 'wildchar' & CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab> | |
7 | 1819 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion |
11062 | 1820 'writebackup' + on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature |
7 | 1821 |
1822 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535* | |
1823 'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i") | |
1824 local to buffer | |
1825 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works | |
1826 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line | |
1827 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion | |
1828 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags: | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
1829 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored) |
7 | 1830 w scan buffers from other windows |
1831 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list | |
1832 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list | |
1833 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list | |
1834 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option | |
703 | 1835 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell| |
7 | 1836 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given, |
1837 patterns are valid too. For example: > | |
1838 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish | |
1839 < s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option | |
1840 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns | |
1841 are valid too. | |
1842 i scan current and included files | |
1843 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro | |
1844 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D| | |
1845 ] tag completion | |
1846 t same as "]" | |
1847 | |
1848 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are | |
1849 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files | |
1850 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for | |
1851 whole-line completion. | |
1852 | |
1853 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan: | |
1854 1. the current buffer | |
1855 2. buffers in other windows | |
1856 3. other loaded buffers | |
1857 4. unloaded buffers | |
1858 5. tags | |
1859 6. included files | |
1860 | |
1861 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'- | |
233 | 1862 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns |
1863 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions). | |
7 | 1864 |
12 | 1865 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'* |
1866 'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty) | |
1867 local to buffer | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1868 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
1869 or |+insert_expand| features} |
623 | 1870 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion |
1871 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U| | |
648 | 1872 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is |
1873 invoked and what it should return. | |
2642 | 1874 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
1875 security reasons. | |
14 | 1876 |
17543
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1877 *'completeslash'* *'csl'* |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1878 'completeslash' 'csl' string (default: "") |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1879 local to buffer |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1880 {not in Vi} {only for MS-Windows} |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1881 When this option is set it overrules 'shellslash' for completion: |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1882 - When this option is set to "slash", a forward slash is used for path |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1883 completion in insert mode. This is useful when editing HTML tag, or |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1884 Makefile with 'noshellslash' on Windows. |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1885 - When this option is set to "backslash", backslash is used. This is |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1886 useful when editing a batch file with 'shellslash' set on Windows. |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1887 - When this option is empty, same character is used as for |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1888 'shellslash'. |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1889 For Insert mode completion the buffer-local value is used. For |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1890 command line completion the global value is used. |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
1891 |
540 | 1892 *'completeopt'* *'cot'* |
730 | 1893 'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview") |
540 | 1894 global |
766 | 1895 {not available when compiled without the |
1896 |+insert_expand| feature} | |
665 | 1897 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion |
1898 |ins-completion|. The supported values are: | |
540 | 1899 |
1900 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The | |
1901 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and | |
1902 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu| | |
1903 | |
707 | 1904 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match. |
856 | 1905 Useful when there is additional information about the |
707 | 1906 match, e.g., what file it comes from. |
1907 | |
836 | 1908 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If |
1909 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more | |
1910 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind | |
1911 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is | |
1912 used. | |
665 | 1913 |
730 | 1914 preview Show extra information about the currently selected |
1152 | 1915 completion in the preview window. Only works in |
1916 combination with "menu" or "menuone". | |
1917 | |
6911 | 1918 noinsert Do not insert any text for a match until the user selects |
1919 a match from the menu. Only works in combination with | |
1920 "menu" or "menuone". No effect if "longest" is present. | |
1921 | |
1922 noselect Do not select a match in the menu, force the user to | |
1923 select one from the menu. Only works in combination with | |
1924 "menu" or "menuone". | |
1925 | |
730 | 1926 |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1927 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'* |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1928 'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "") |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1929 local to window |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1930 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal| |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1931 feature} |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1932 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed. |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1933 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1934 other lines. |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1935 n Normal mode |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1936 v Visual mode |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1937 i Insert mode |
2382
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1938 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch' |
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1939 |
2400
e6f1424dd66a
Let 'v' flag in 'concealcursor' apply to all lines in the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2394
diff
changeset
|
1940 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor. |
2382
3a5ededa240a
Add the 'c' flag to 'concealcursor'.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2380
diff
changeset
|
1941 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1942 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1943 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1944 you can see what you are doing. |
2380
b47748aa3236
Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2378
diff
changeset
|
1945 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's |
b47748aa3236
Don't conceal text in lines inside the Visual area.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2378
diff
changeset
|
1946 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column. |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1947 |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1948 |
14864 | 1949 *'conceallevel'* *'cole'* |
1950 'conceallevel' 'cole' number (default 0) | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1951 local to window |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1952 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal| |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1953 feature} |
2340
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1954 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal| |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1955 is shown: |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1956 |
99c1eba60b2d
Make automatic prototype generation work with more interfaces.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2337
diff
changeset
|
1957 Value Effect ~ |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1958 0 Text is shown normally |
2426 | 1959 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one |
1960 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom | |
1961 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the | |
1962 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a | |
1963 space). | |
1964 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group. | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1965 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1966 custom replacement character defined (see |
2426 | 1967 |:syn-cchar|). |
2349
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1968 3 Concealed text is completely hidden. |
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1969 |
586a459f3980
Never hide text for conceal in cursor line. Do hide when there is
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2348
diff
changeset
|
1970 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can |
2378
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1971 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor' |
85b7dc8da5eb
Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2365
diff
changeset
|
1972 option. |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
1973 |
7 | 1974 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'* |
1975 'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off) | |
1976 global | |
1977 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally | |
1978 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e", | |
1979 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current | |
1980 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer. | |
1981 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one | |
1982 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm| | |
1983 command. | |
1984 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'. | |
1985 | |
1986 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'* | |
1987 'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off) | |
1988 global | |
8246
f16bfe02cef1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f391327adbbffb11180cf6038a92af1ed144e907
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8182
diff
changeset
|
1989 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported. |
7 | 1990 |
1991 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'* | |
1992 'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off) | |
1993 local to buffer | |
1994 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a | |
1995 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of | |
1996 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled, | |
1997 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the | |
1998 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the | |
1621 | 1999 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab |
2000 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing | |
7 | 2001 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner. |
11160 | 2002 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 2003 Also see 'preserveindent'. |
2004 | |
8148
f5da459c5698
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e0fa3742ead676a3074a10edadbc955e1a89153d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8061
diff
changeset
|
2005 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* *cpo* |
7 | 2006 'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs", |
2007 Vi default: all flags) | |
2008 global | |
2009 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present | |
5340 | 2010 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where |
2011 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred. | |
7 | 2012 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options". |
2013 Commas can be added for readability. | |
2014 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
2015 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
2016 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
2017 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
164 | 2018 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when |
2019 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2020 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2021 POSIX specification. |
7 | 2022 |
2023 contains behavior ~ | |
2024 *cpo-a* | |
2025 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name | |
2026 argument will set the alternate file name for the | |
2027 current window. | |
2028 *cpo-A* | |
2029 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name | |
2030 argument will set the alternate file name for the | |
2031 current window. | |
2032 *cpo-b* | |
2033 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of | |
2034 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping, | |
2035 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next | |
2036 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to | |
2037 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all | |
2038 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands. | |
2039 See also |map_bar|. | |
2040 *cpo-B* | |
2041 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings, | |
14372 | 2042 abbreviations, user commands and the "to" part of the |
2043 menu commands. Remove this flag to be able to use a | |
2044 backslash like a CTRL-V. For example, the command | |
2045 ":map X \<Esc>" results in X being mapped to: | |
7 | 2046 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>) |
2047 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters) | |
2048 ('<' excluded in both cases) | |
2049 *cpo-c* | |
2050 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the | |
2051 cursor position, but not further than the start of the | |
2052 next line. When not present searching continues | |
2053 one character from the cursor position. With 'c' | |
2054 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating | |
2055 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches. | |
2056 *cpo-C* | |
2057 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a | |
2058 backslash. See |line-continuation|. | |
2059 *cpo-d* | |
2060 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use | |
2061 the tags file relative to the current file, but the | |
2062 tags file in the current directory. | |
2063 *cpo-D* | |
2064 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode | |
2065 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and | |
2066 |t|. | |
2067 *cpo-e* | |
2068 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a | |
2069 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not | |
2070 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register | |
2071 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a | |
2072 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line | |
2073 and can be edited before hitting <CR>. | |
2074 *cpo-E* | |
2075 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or | |
2076 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when | |
13818
28ac7914b2b6
Update runtime files and translations
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13742
diff
changeset
|
2077 at least one character is to be operated on. Example: |
7 | 2078 This makes "y0" fail in the first column. |
2079 *cpo-f* | |
2080 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name | |
2081 argument will set the file name for the current buffer, | |
2082 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet. | |
2083 *cpo-F* | |
2084 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name | |
2085 argument will set the file name for the current | |
2086 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name | |
590 | 2087 yet. Also see |cpo-P|. |
7 | 2088 *cpo-g* |
2089 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument. | |
164 | 2090 *cpo-H* |
2091 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert | |
2092 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after | |
2093 the last blank. | |
7 | 2094 *cpo-i* |
2095 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will | |
2096 leave it modified. | |
10 | 2097 *cpo-I* |
2098 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting | |
2099 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent. | |
7 | 2100 *cpo-j* |
2101 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.', | |
2102 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'. | |
2103 *cpo-J* | |
2104 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after | |
233 | 2105 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as |
7 | 2106 white space. |
2107 *cpo-k* | |
2108 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in | |
2109 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu | |
2110 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[ | |
2111 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X | |
2112 being mapped to: | |
2113 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters) | |
2114 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code) | |
2115 Also see the '<' flag below. | |
2116 *cpo-K* | |
2117 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is | |
2118 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when | |
2119 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It | |
2120 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>. | |
2121 *cpo-l* | |
2122 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken | |
168 | 2123 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special. |
2124 See |/[]| | |
7 | 2125 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't' |
2126 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab> | |
168 | 2127 Also see |cpo-\|. |
7 | 2128 *cpo-L* |
2129 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin', | |
2130 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode | |
2131 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of | |
2132 the normal behavior of a <Tab>. | |
2133 *cpo-m* | |
2134 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a | |
2135 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half | |
2136 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'| | |
2137 *cpo-M* | |
2138 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into | |
2139 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer | |
2140 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores | |
2141 backslashes, which is Vi compatible. | |
2142 *cpo-n* | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2143 n When included, the column used for 'number' and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2144 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
2145 lines. |
7 | 2146 *cpo-o* |
2147 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for | |
2148 next search. | |
2149 *cpo-O* | |
2150 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even | |
2151 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a | |
2152 protection against a file unexpectedly created by | |
2153 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this. | |
2154 *cpo-p* | |
2155 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a | |
2156 slightly better algorithm is used. | |
590 | 2157 *cpo-P* |
2158 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a | |
2159 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if | |
2160 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and | |
2161 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|. | |
164 | 2162 *cpo-q* |
2163 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the | |
2164 position where it would be when joining two lines. | |
7 | 2165 *cpo-r* |
2166 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search | |
2167 command, instead of the actually used search string. | |
2168 *cpo-R* | |
2169 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag | |
2170 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used. | |
2171 *cpo-s* | |
2172 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the | |
2173 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0. | |
10 | 2174 And it is the default. If not present the options are |
7 | 2175 set when the buffer is created. |
2176 *cpo-S* | |
2177 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer | |
2178 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and | |
2179 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting. | |
2180 The options are set to the values in the current | |
2181 buffer. When you change an option and go to another | |
2182 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the | |
2183 buffer options global to all buffers. | |
2184 | |
2185 's' 'S' copy buffer options | |
2186 no no when buffer created | |
2187 yes no when buffer first entered (default) | |
2188 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.) | |
2189 *cpo-t* | |
2190 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for | |
2191 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in | |
2192 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the | |
2193 last used search pattern. | |
2194 *cpo-u* | |
10 | 2195 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|. |
7 | 2196 *cpo-v* |
2197 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in | |
2198 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are | |
2199 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the | |
2200 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced | |
2201 characters. | |
2202 *cpo-w* | |
2203 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one | |
2204 character and not all blanks until the start of the | |
2205 next word. | |
2206 *cpo-W* | |
2207 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!" | |
2208 overwrites a readonly file, if possible. | |
2209 *cpo-x* | |
2210 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line. | |
2211 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line, | |
2212 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>| | |
164 | 2213 *cpo-X* |
2214 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is | |
2215 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "." | |
2216 and a count. | |
7 | 2217 *cpo-y* |
15512 | 2218 y A yank command can be redone with ".". Think twice if |
2219 you really want to use this, it may break some | |
2220 plugins, since most people expect "." to only repeat a | |
2221 change. | |
164 | 2222 *cpo-Z* |
2223 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set, | |
2224 don't reset 'readonly'. | |
7 | 2225 *cpo-!* |
2226 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used | |
2227 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last | |
2228 used -filter- command is used. | |
2229 *cpo-$* | |
2230 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the | |
2231 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text. | |
2232 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the | |
2233 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any | |
2234 command that moves the cursor from the insertion | |
2235 point. | |
2236 *cpo-%* | |
2237 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command. | |
2238 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc. | |
2239 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/". | |
2240 Parens inside single and double quotes are also | |
2241 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to | |
2242 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like | |
2243 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not | |
2244 match the last one. When this flag is not included, | |
2245 parens inside single and double quotes are treated | |
2246 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes, | |
2247 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a | |
2248 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if | |
10 | 2249 there is one). This works very well for C programs. |
36 | 2250 This flag is also used for other features, such as |
2251 C-indenting. | |
161 | 2252 *cpo--* |
2253 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when | |
632 | 2254 it would go above the first line or below the last |
2255 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or | |
2256 last line, unless it already was in that line. | |
161 | 2257 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j", |
632 | 2258 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234". |
39 | 2259 *cpo-+* |
2260 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the | |
2261 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer | |
2262 itself may still be different from its file. | |
856 | 2263 *cpo-star* |
7 | 2264 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included, |
2265 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area. | |
2266 *cpo-<* | |
2267 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>| | |
2268 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of | |
10 | 2269 menu commands. For example, the command |
7 | 2270 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to: |
2271 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters) | |
2272 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>) | |
2273 Also see the 'k' flag above. | |
164 | 2274 *cpo->* |
2275 > When appending to a register, put a line break before | |
2276 the appended text. | |
2925 | 2277 *cpo-;* |
2278 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search | |
2279 and the cursor is right in front of the searched | |
2280 character, the cursor won't move. When not included, | |
2281 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the | |
3557 | 2282 following occurrence. |
164 | 2283 |
2284 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except | |
2285 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix| | |
2286 | |
2287 contains behavior ~ | |
856 | 2288 *cpo-#* |
164 | 2289 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect. |
168 | 2290 *cpo-&* |
2291 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when | |
2292 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded. | |
2293 This flag is tested when exiting. | |
2294 *cpo-\* | |
2295 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken | |
2296 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]| | |
488 | 2297 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-' |
2298 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-' | |
2299 Also see |cpo-l|. | |
168 | 2300 *cpo-/* |
2301 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s| | |
2302 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%| | |
164 | 2303 *cpo-{* |
2304 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character | |
2305 at the start of a line. | |
168 | 2306 *cpo-.* |
2307 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current | |
2308 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't | |
2309 need this, since it remembers the full path of an | |
2310 opened file. | |
164 | 2311 *cpo-bar* |
2312 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment | |
2313 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained | |
2314 with system specific functions. | |
2315 | |
7 | 2316 |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2317 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'* |
15192
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2318 'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "blowfish2") |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2319 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2320 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file: |
2184
5028c4d6d825
Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2180
diff
changeset
|
2321 *pkzip* |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2322 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption. |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2323 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older. |
2184
5028c4d6d825
Fixed encryption big/little endian test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2180
diff
changeset
|
2324 *blowfish* |
6122 | 2325 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has |
2326 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later, | |
2327 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds | |
2328 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file | |
2329 the encrypted bytes will be different. | |
2330 *blowfish2* | |
2331 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires | |
7876
93f747af7b58
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5e9b2fa9bb0e6061cf18457c173cd141a5dc9c92
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7687
diff
changeset
|
2332 Vim 7.4.401 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3 |
6122 | 2333 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time |
2334 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be | |
2335 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just | |
2336 the pieces of text. | |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2337 |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
2338 You should use "blowfish2", also to re-encrypt older files. |
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
2339 |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2340 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2341 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2342 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used. |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2343 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2344 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2345 modifications. Also see |:X|. |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2346 |
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2347 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with |
15192
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2348 the value "blowfish2". When setting the local value to an empty |
690da0a83419
patch 8.1.0606: 'cryptmethod' defaults to a very old method
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15131
diff
changeset
|
2349 string the buffer will use the global value. |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2350 |
2204
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2351 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and |
c493d6bfde09
A few more changes for encryption. Add test that encrypted file can be read.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2184
diff
changeset
|
2352 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* . |
2360
d8e4b27cef80
Change 'cryptmethod' from a number to a string option. Make it global-local.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2350
diff
changeset
|
2353 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim. |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2354 |
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
2355 |
7 | 2356 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'* |
2357 'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0) | |
2358 global | |
2359 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2360 feature} | |
2361 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags. | |
2362 See |cscopepathcomp|. | |
11160 | 2363 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 2364 |
2365 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'* | |
2366 'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope") | |
2367 global | |
2368 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2369 feature} | |
2370 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|. | |
2371 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2372 security reasons. | |
2373 | |
2374 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'* | |
2375 'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "") | |
2376 global | |
2377 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2378 or |+quickfix| features} | |
2379 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results. | |
2380 See |cscopequickfix|. | |
2381 | |
4869 | 2382 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'* |
2873 | 2383 'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off) |
2384 global | |
2385 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2386 feature} | |
2387 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables | |
2388 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix. | |
2389 See |cscoperelative|. | |
11160 | 2390 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2873 | 2391 |
7 | 2392 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'* |
2393 'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off) | |
2394 global | |
2395 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2396 feature} | |
2397 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|. | |
2398 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2399 | |
2400 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'* | |
2401 'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0) | |
2402 global | |
2403 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2404 feature} | |
2405 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See | |
2406 |cscopetagorder|. | |
2407 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
2408 | |
2409 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'* | |
2410 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'* | |
2411 'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off) | |
2412 global | |
2413 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope| | |
2414 feature} | |
2415 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|. | |
2416 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2417 | |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2418 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'* |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2419 'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off) |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2420 local to window |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2421 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2422 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2423 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2424 column. This option is useful for viewing the |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2425 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode, |
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2426 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are |
2314
233eb4412f5d
Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2302
diff
changeset
|
2427 taken into account. |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
2428 |
743 | 2429 |
2430 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'* | |
2431 'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off) | |
2432 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2433 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
743 | 2434 feature} |
2435 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn | |
2436 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing | |
2437 slower. | |
826 | 2438 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use |
2439 these autocommands: > | |
2440 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn | |
2441 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn | |
2442 < | |
743 | 2443 |
2444 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'* | |
2445 'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off) | |
2446 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2447 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| |
743 | 2448 feature} |
2449 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine | |
2450 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen | |
2451 redrawing slower. | |
818 | 2452 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it |
825 | 2453 easier to see the selected text. |
743 | 2454 |
2455 | |
7 | 2456 *'debug'* |
2457 'debug' string (default "") | |
2458 global | |
839 | 2459 These values can be used: |
2460 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given | |
2461 anyway. | |
2462 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given | |
2463 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|. | |
2464 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be | |
2465 produced. | |
168 | 2466 The values can be combined, separated by a comma. |
839 | 2467 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or |
2468 'indentexpr'. | |
7 | 2469 |
2470 *'define'* *'def'* | |
2471 'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define") | |
2472 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
10 | 2473 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search |
7 | 2474 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the |
2475 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is | |
2476 used to recognize the defined name after the match: | |
2477 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char} | |
2478 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space | |
2479 or backslash. | |
2480 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be | |
2481 useful, to include const type declarations: > | |
2482 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\) | |
16086 | 2483 < You can also use "\ze" just before the name and continue the pattern |
2484 to check what is following. E.g. for Javascript, if a function is | |
2485 defined with "func_name = function(args)": > | |
2486 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*=\s*function( | |
2487 < If the function is defined with "func_name : function() {...": > | |
2488 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*[:]\s*(*function\s*( | |
7 | 2489 < When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes! |
16086 | 2490 To avoid that use `:let` with a single quote string: > |
2491 let &l:define = '^\s*\ze\k\+\s*=\s*function(' | |
16380 | 2492 < |
7 | 2493 |
2494 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'* | |
2495 'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off) | |
2496 global | |
2497 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode | |
2498 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the | |
2499 default) the character along with its combining characters are | |
2500 deleted. | |
2501 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"! | |
2502 | |
2503 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one | |
2504 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want | |
2505 to remove only the combining ones. | |
11160 | 2506 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 2507 |
2508 *'dictionary'* *'dict'* | |
2509 'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "") | |
2510 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2511 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words | |
2512 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should | |
2513 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several | |
2514 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is | |
2515 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes. | |
13950
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2516 |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2517 When this option is empty or an entry "spell" is present, and spell |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2518 checking is enabled, words in the word lists for the currently active |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2519 'spelllang' are used. See |spell|. |
741b1feeac9f
patch 8.0.1845: various comment updates needed, missing white space
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13818
diff
changeset
|
2520 |
10 | 2521 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces |
7 | 2522 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file |
2523 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. | |
99 | 2524 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type. |
7 | 2525 Where to find a list of words? |
2526 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words". | |
2527 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory. | |
2528 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection. | |
2529 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
2530 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
2531 uses another default. | |
2532 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons. | |
2533 | |
2534 *'diff'* *'nodiff'* | |
2535 'diff' boolean (default off) | |
2536 local to window | |
2537 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2538 feature} | |
2539 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences | |
10 | 2540 between files. See |vimdiff|. |
7 | 2541 |
2542 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'* | |
2543 'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "") | |
2544 global | |
2545 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2546 feature} | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2547 Expression which is evaluated to obtain a diff file (either ed-style |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2548 or unified-style) from two versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|. |
7 | 2549 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
2550 security reasons. | |
2551 | |
2552 *'dip'* *'diffopt'* | |
14702
daf8afe6279b
patch 8.1.0363: internal diff isn't used by default as advertised
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14696
diff
changeset
|
2553 'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "internal,filler") |
7 | 2554 global |
2555 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
2556 feature} | |
10 | 2557 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items. |
7 | 2558 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma. |
2559 | |
2560 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text | |
2561 synchronized with a window that has inserted | |
2562 lines at the same position. Mostly useful | |
2563 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind' | |
2564 is set. | |
2565 | |
2566 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change | |
2567 and a fold that contains unchanged lines. | |
2568 When omitted a context of six lines is used. | |
15932 | 2569 When using zero the context is actually one, |
2570 since folds require a line in between, also | |
2571 for a deleted line. | |
7 | 2572 See |fold-diff|. |
2573 | |
14864 | 2574 iblank Ignore changes where lines are all blank. Adds |
2575 the "-B" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2576 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2577 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2578 exactly. | |
2579 NOTE: the diff windows will get out of sync, | |
2580 because no differences between blank lines are | |
2581 taken into account. | |
2582 | |
7 | 2583 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A" |
2584 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag | |
2585 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty. | |
2586 | |
2587 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds | |
2588 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2589 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2590 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2591 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing | |
2592 white space, but not leading white space. | |
2593 | |
14864 | 2594 iwhiteall Ignore all white space changes. Adds |
2595 the "-w" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2596 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2597 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2598 exactly. | |
2599 | |
2600 iwhiteeol Ignore white space changes at end of line. | |
2601 Adds the "-Z" flag to the "diff" command if | |
2602 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation | |
2603 of the "diff" command for what this does | |
2604 exactly. | |
2605 | |
766 | 2606 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless |
2607 explicitly specified otherwise). | |
2608 | |
2609 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless | |
2610 explicitly specified otherwise). | |
2611 | |
12971
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2612 hiddenoff Do not use diff mode for a buffer when it |
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2613 becomes hidden. |
ca3cb1997f08
patch 8.0.1361: some users don't want to diff with hidden buffers
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12968
diff
changeset
|
2614 |
766 | 2615 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when |
2616 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used. | |
2617 | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2618 internal Use the internal diff library. This is |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2619 ignored when 'diffexpr' is set. *E960* |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2620 When running out of memory when writing a |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2621 buffer this item will be ignored for diffs |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2622 involving that buffer. Set the 'verbose' |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2623 option to see when this happens. |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2624 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2625 indent-heuristic |
15033 | 2626 Use the indent heuristic for the internal |
2627 diff library. | |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2628 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2629 algorithm:{text} Use the specified diff algorithm with the |
15033 | 2630 internal diff engine. Currently supported |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2631 algorithms are: |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2632 myers the default algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2633 minimal spend extra time to generate the |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2634 smallest possible diff |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2635 patience patience diff algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2636 histogram histogram diff algorithm |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2637 |
7 | 2638 Examples: > |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2639 :set diffopt=internal,filler,context:4 |
7 | 2640 :set diffopt= |
14696
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2641 :set diffopt=internal,filler,foldcolumn:3 |
195e8b1fcbbf
patch 8.1.0360: using an external diff program is slow and inflexible
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14695
diff
changeset
|
2642 :set diffopt-=internal " do NOT use the internal diff parser |
7 | 2643 < |
2644 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'* | |
2645 'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off) | |
2646 global | |
2647 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs| | |
2648 feature} | |
2649 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS> | |
2650 {char2}. See |digraphs|. | |
2651 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
2652 | |
2653 *'directory'* *'dir'* | |
2654 'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:", | |
5555 | 2655 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp" |
7 | 2656 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp") |
2657 global | |
2658 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas. | |
2659 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is | |
2660 possible. | |
2661 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is | |
2662 impossible!). | |
2663 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as | |
2664 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so | |
2665 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden" | |
2666 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible. | |
33 | 2667 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to |
7 | 2668 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading |
2669 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file. | |
14475
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2670 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//", |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2671 the swap file name will be built from the complete path to the file |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2672 with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs. This will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2673 ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory. |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2674 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2675 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2676 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to |
dddba3937532
patch 8.1.0251: using full path is not supported for 'backupdir'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14421
diff
changeset
|
2677 use '//', instead of '\\'. |
7 | 2678 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part |
2679 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory | |
2680 name, precede it with a backslash. | |
2681 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash. | |
2682 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'. | |
2683 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
2684 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to | |
2685 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: > | |
2686 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces | |
2687 < - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start | |
2688 of the option is removed. | |
2689 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing | |
2690 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is | |
2691 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file. | |
2692 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better | |
2693 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap | |
2694 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your | |
2695 home directory is tried first. | |
2696 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
2697 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
2698 uses another default. | |
2699 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2700 security reasons. | |
2701 | |
2702 *'display'* *'dy'* | |
9737
35ce559b8553
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc8801c9317eb721a2ee91322669f2dd5d136380
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9669
diff
changeset
|
2703 'display' 'dy' string (default "", set to "truncate" in |
35ce559b8553
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc8801c9317eb721a2ee91322669f2dd5d136380
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9669
diff
changeset
|
2704 |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 2705 global |
2706 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of | |
2707 flags: | |
2708 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line | |
9665
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2709 in a window will be displayed. "@@@" is put in the |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2710 last columns of the last screen line to indicate the |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2711 rest of the line is not displayed. |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2712 truncate Like "lastline", but "@@@" is displayed in the first |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2713 column of the last screen line. Overrules "lastline". |
7 | 2714 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx> |
2715 instead of using ^C and ~C. | |
2716 | |
10211
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
2717 When neither "lastline" nor "truncate" is included, a last line that |
9665
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2718 doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines. |
b193bdb6ea25
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ad9c2a08f0509294269a2f11a59a438b944bdd5a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9533
diff
changeset
|
2719 |
7 | 2720 *'eadirection'* *'ead'* |
2721 'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both") | |
2722 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
2723 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 2724 feature} |
2725 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies: | |
2726 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected | |
2727 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected | |
2728 both width and height of windows is affected | |
2729 | |
2730 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'* | |
2731 'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off) | |
2732 global | |
2733 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be | |
2734 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See | |
2735 also 'gdefault' option. | |
11442 | 2736 Switching this option on may break plugins! |
7 | 2737 |
8876
47f17f66da3d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/03413f44167c4b5cd0012def9bb331e2518c83cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8835
diff
changeset
|
2738 *'emoji'* *'emo'* *'noemoji'* *'noemo'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2739 'emoji' 'emo' boolean (default: on) |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2740 global |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2741 When on all Unicode emoji characters are considered to be full width. |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2742 |
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
2743 |
7 | 2744 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543* |
2745 'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG) | |
2746 global | |
2747 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in | |
2748 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the | |
2749 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work | |
2750 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values. | |
2751 | |
2752 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the | |
39 | 2753 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid. |
7 | 2754 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim |
1152 | 2755 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|. |
7 | 2756 |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2757 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2758 corrupt the text. |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2759 |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
2760 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 or later, it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' |
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
2761 to "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of |
7 | 2762 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and |
2763 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made | |
10 | 2764 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal |
7 | 2765 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files |
2766 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty). | |
2767 | |
2768 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'. | |
10 | 2769 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with |
7 | 2770 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'. |
2771 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2772 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multi-byte encoding, you |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2773 can use: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2774 if has("multi_byte_encoding") |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2775 < |
7 | 2776 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will |
2777 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If | |
2778 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be | |
2779 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|. | |
2780 | |
2781 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand | |
2782 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary. | |
2783 | |
2784 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus | |
2785 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated | |
2786 to '-' signs. | |
2787 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name. | |
2788 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes | |
2789 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8". | |
2790 | |
2791 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected. | |
2792 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the | |
2793 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and | |
2794 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using | |
2795 utf-8. | |
2796 | |
2797 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8. | |
2798 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the | |
2799 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus | |
2800 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has | |
2801 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty. | |
448 | 2802 |
2803 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was | |
2804 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed. | |
7 | 2805 |
2806 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'* | |
2807 'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on) | |
2808 local to buffer | |
2809 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option | |
6933 | 2810 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no <EOL> will be written for the |
2811 last line in the file. This option is automatically set or reset when | |
2812 starting to edit a new file, depending on whether file has an <EOL> | |
2813 for the last line in the file. Normally you don't have to set or | |
2814 reset this option. | |
2815 When 'binary' is off and 'fixeol' is on the value is not used when | |
2816 writing the file. When 'binary' is on or 'fixeol' is off it is used | |
2817 to remember the presence of a <EOL> for the last line in the file, so | |
2818 that when you write the file the situation from the original file can | |
2819 be kept. But you can change it if you want to. | |
7 | 2820 |
2821 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'* | |
2822 'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on) | |
2823 global | |
2824 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after | |
33 | 2825 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the |
2826 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the | |
2827 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When | |
2828 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it | |
2829 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright'). | |
7 | 2830 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size |
2831 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The | |
2832 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected. | |
1354 | 2833 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting |
2834 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2835 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2836 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2837 the future). |
7 | 2838 |
2839 *'equalprg'* *'ep'* | |
2840 'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "") | |
2841 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2842 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty | |
1621 | 2843 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent' |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2844 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2845 the "indent" program is used. |
10 | 2846 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
7 | 2847 about including spaces and backslashes. |
2848 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2849 security reasons. | |
2850 | |
2851 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'* | |
2852 'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off) | |
2853 global | |
2854 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only | |
2855 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always | |
2856 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal | |
10 | 2857 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep, |
6949 | 2858 screen flash or do nothing. See 'belloff' to finetune when to ring the |
2859 bell. | |
7 | 2860 |
2861 *'errorfile'* *'ef'* | |
2862 'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err", | |
2863 others: "errors.err") | |
2864 global | |
2865 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
2866 feature} | |
2867 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|). | |
2868 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the | |
2869 following argument. See |-q|. | |
2870 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that. | |
2871 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
2872 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
2873 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
2874 security reasons. | |
2875 | |
2876 *'errorformat'* *'efm'* | |
2877 'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long) | |
2878 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
2879 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
2880 feature} | |
2881 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file | |
2882 (see |errorformat|). | |
2883 | |
2884 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'* | |
2885 'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
2886 global | |
2887 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert | |
2888 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be | |
2889 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of | |
2890 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of | |
2891 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to | |
2892 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that | |
2893 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys | |
2894 won't work by default. | |
2895 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
2896 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
2897 | |
2898 *'eventignore'* *'ei'* | |
2899 'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "") | |
2900 global | |
2901 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored. | |
844 | 2902 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand |
2903 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed. | |
7 | 2904 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: > |
2905 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave | |
2906 < | |
2907 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'* | |
2908 'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off) | |
2909 local to buffer | |
2910 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a | |
10 | 2911 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and |
7 | 2912 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is |
2913 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
2914 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and restored when |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
2915 the 'paste' option is reset. |
7 | 2916 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2917 | |
2918 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'* | |
2919 'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off) | |
2920 global | |
2921 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current | |
10027
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2922 directory. |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2923 |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2924 Setting this option is a potential security leak. E.g., consider |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2925 unpacking a package or fetching files from github, a .vimrc in there |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2926 might be a trojan horse. BETTER NOT SET THIS OPTION! |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2927 Instead, define an autocommand in your .vimrc to set options for a |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2928 matching directory. |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2929 |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2930 If you do switch this option on you should also consider setting the |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2931 'secure' option (see |initialization|). |
018fead968c1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/36f44c21da2e912c008683a0c4447fca2a071e9a
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9975
diff
changeset
|
2932 Also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|. |
7 | 2933 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
2934 security reasons. | |
2935 | |
2936 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213* | |
2937 'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "") | |
2938 local to buffer | |
2939 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2940 |
7 | 2941 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2942 done when writing the file. For reading see below. |
7 | 2943 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be |
2944 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file). | |
11062 | 2945 No error will be given when the value is set, only when it is used, |
2946 only when writing a file. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2947 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2948 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2949 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8. |
7 | 2950 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2951 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2952 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2953 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
2954 characters may be lost! |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2955 |
7 | 2956 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be |
2957 specified that can be handled by the converter, see | |
2958 |mbyte-conversion|. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2959 |
7 | 2960 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'. |
2961 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting | |
1152 | 2962 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when |
2963 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used. | |
692 | 2964 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used. |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2965 |
7 | 2966 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored. |
2967 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus | |
2968 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are | |
2969 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for | |
2970 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example | |
2971 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2". | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2972 |
7 | 2973 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified' |
2974 option is set, because the file would be different when written. | |
2317
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2975 |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2976 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2977 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2978 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2979 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q". |
2b2cd34569eb
Disallow setting 'enc' in a modeline. (Patrick Texier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2314
diff
changeset
|
2980 |
7 | 2981 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off. |
2982 | |
2983 *'fe'* | |
2984 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the | |
10 | 2985 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The |
7 | 2986 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used. |
2987 | |
2988 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'* | |
39 | 2989 'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom", |
2990 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when | |
2991 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value) | |
7 | 2992 global |
2993 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit | |
2994 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first | |
2995 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one | |
2996 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works, | |
10 | 2997 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to |
7 | 2998 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used. |
2999 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When | |
3000 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants) | |
3001 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse | |
3002 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not | |
596 | 3003 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use |
3004 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters | |
3005 that can't be converted. | |
7 | 3006 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings |
3007 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except | |
3008 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer | |
3009 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your | |
3010 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: > | |
3011 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 | | |
3012 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif | |
3013 < This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain | |
3014 non-blank characters. | |
596 | 3015 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is |
3016 not used. | |
692 | 3017 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value |
3018 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: > | |
3019 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2 | |
3020 < This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than | |
3021 an empty file. | |
7 | 3022 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM |
3023 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded | |
3024 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly. | |
3025 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last, | |
3026 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always | |
3027 accepted. | |
39 | 3028 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the |
3029 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful | |
3030 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a | |
3031 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian. | |
777 | 3032 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte |
3033 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8| | |
3034 command to find the illegal byte sequence. | |
7 | 3035 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG: |
3036 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used | |
3037 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8 | |
3038 file | |
3039 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used | |
3040 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified. | |
3041 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values. | |
3042 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file | |
3043 is read. | |
3044 | |
3045 *'fileformat'* *'ff'* | |
15840
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3046 'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-Windows default: "dos", |
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3047 Unix, macOS default: "unix") |
7 | 3048 local to buffer |
3049 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for | |
3050 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file: | |
3051 dos <CR> <NL> | |
3052 unix <NL> | |
3053 mac <CR> | |
3054 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored. | |
3055 See |file-formats| and |file-read|. | |
3056 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'. | |
3057 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O | |
4264 | 3058 works like it was set to "unix". |
7 | 3059 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and |
3060 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off. | |
3061 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified' | |
3062 option is set, because the file would be different when written. | |
3063 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off. | |
3064 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos", | |
3065 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset. | |
3066 | |
3067 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'* | |
3068 'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default: | |
15840
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3069 Vim+Vi MS-Windows: "dos,unix", |
734b1928a5aa
patch 8.1.0927: USE_CR is never defined
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15804
diff
changeset
|
3070 Vim Unix, macOS: "unix,dos", |
7 | 3071 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos", |
3072 Vi others: "") | |
3073 global | |
3074 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when | |
3075 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing | |
3076 buffer: | |
3077 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used | |
3078 always. It is not set automatically. | |
3079 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer | |
10 | 3080 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The |
7 | 3081 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing |
3082 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to. | |
3083 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic | |
3084 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to | |
3085 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>: | |
3086 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos", | |
3087 'fileformat' is set to "dos". | |
3088 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat' | |
10 | 3089 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a |
7 | 3090 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos". |
6647 | 3091 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and |
3092 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac". | |
2587 | 3093 This means that "mac" is only chosen when: |
3094 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and | |
3095 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file. | |
3096 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before | |
3097 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in | |
2642 | 3098 the first few lines, "mac" is used. |
7 | 3099 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from |
3100 'fileformats' is used. | |
3101 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but | |
3102 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that | |
3103 file only, the option is not changed. | |
3104 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used. | |
3105 | |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
3106 When Vim starts up with an empty buffer the first item is used. You |
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
3107 can overrule this by setting 'fileformat' in your .vimrc. |
2662 | 3108 |
7 | 3109 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that |
3110 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be | |
3111 done: | |
3112 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos | |
3113 format will be used. | |
3114 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection | |
3115 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a | |
3116 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is | |
3117 used. | |
3118 Also see |file-formats|. | |
3119 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty | |
3120 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset, | |
3121 otherwise 'textauto' is set. | |
3122 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
3123 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
3124 | |
4264 | 3125 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'* |
3126 'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file | |
3127 names is normally ignored) | |
4242 | 3128 global |
3129 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories. | |
3130 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion. | |
3131 | |
7 | 3132 *'filetype'* *'ft'* |
3133 'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "") | |
3134 local to buffer | |
3135 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered. | |
3136 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be | |
3137 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file | |
3138 name. | |
3139 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type. | |
3140 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable | |
3141 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype| | |
3142 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline, | |
3143 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized. | |
782 | 3144 Example, for in an IDL file: |
3145 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~ | |
3146 |FileType| |filetypes| | |
3147 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype | |
3148 names. Example: | |
3149 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~ | |
3150 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype. | |
3151 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than | |
3152 one dot may appear. | |
7 | 3153 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or |
3154 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'. | |
36 | 3155 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 3156 |
3157 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'* | |
3158 'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-") | |
3159 global | |
3160 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| | |
3161 and |+folding| features} | |
3162 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators. | |
3163 It is a comma separated list of items: | |
3164 | |
3165 item default Used for ~ | |
3166 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window | |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3167 stlnc:c ' ' or '=' statusline of the non-current windows |
7 | 3168 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit| |
3169 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext' | |
3170 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option | |
3171 | |
10 | 3172 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3173 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '=' |
7 | 3174 otherwise. |
3175 | |
3176 Example: > | |
8061
abd64cf67bcf
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/38a55639d603823efcf2d2fdf542dbffdeb60b75
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7876
diff
changeset
|
3177 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:=,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:- |
7 | 3178 < This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also |
3179 be used when there is highlighting. | |
3180 | |
819 | 3181 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported. |
3182 | |
7 | 3183 The highlighting used for these items: |
3184 item highlight group ~ | |
3185 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine| | |
3186 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC| | |
3187 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit| | |
3188 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded| | |
3189 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete| | |
3190 | |
6933 | 3191 *'fixendofline'* *'fixeol'* *'nofixendofline'* *'nofixeol'* |
3192 'fixendofline' 'fixeol' boolean (default on) | |
3193 local to buffer | |
3194 When writing a file and this option is on, <EOL> at the end of file | |
3195 will be restored if missing. Turn this option off if you want to | |
3196 preserve the situation from the original file. | |
3197 When the 'binary' option is set the value of this option doesn't | |
3198 matter. | |
3199 See the 'endofline' option. | |
3200 | |
7 | 3201 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'* |
3202 'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198* | |
3203 global | |
3204 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3205 feature} | |
15850
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
3206 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See |
a6ca8cf07a98
patch 8.1.0932: Farsi support is outdated and unused
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15840
diff
changeset
|
3207 |farsi.txt|. |
7 | 3208 |
3209 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'* | |
3210 'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "") | |
3211 global | |
3212 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3213 feature} | |
3214 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and | |
3215 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to | |
3216 automatically close when moving out of them. | |
3217 | |
3218 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'* | |
3219 'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0) | |
3220 local to window | |
3221 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3222 feature} | |
3223 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side | |
3224 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum | |
3225 value is 12. | |
3226 See |folding|. | |
3227 | |
3228 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'* | |
3229 'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on) | |
3230 local to window | |
3231 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3232 feature} | |
3233 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly | |
3234 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with | |
3235 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled | |
10 | 3236 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when |
7 | 3237 'foldenable' is off. |
3238 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold. | |
3239 See |folding|. | |
3240 | |
3241 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'* | |
3242 'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0") | |
3243 local to window | |
3244 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3245 or |+eval| features} |
7 | 3246 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated |
634 | 3247 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|. |
782 | 3248 |
3682 | 3249 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a |
3250 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3251 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3252 on or the 'modelineexpr' option is off. |
634 | 3253 |
3254 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
3255 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|. | |
7 | 3256 |
3257 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'* | |
3258 'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#") | |
3259 local to window | |
3260 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3261 feature} | |
3262 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with | |
3263 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding | |
10 | 3264 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character. |
7 | 3265 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|. |
3266 | |
3267 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'* | |
3268 'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0) | |
3269 local to window | |
3270 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3271 feature} | |
3272 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed. | |
3273 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will | |
3274 close fewer folds. | |
3275 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|. | |
3276 See |fold-foldlevel|. | |
3277 | |
3278 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'* | |
3279 'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1) | |
3280 global | |
3281 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3282 feature} | |
3283 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window. | |
3284 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero), | |
3285 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99). | |
3286 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline | |
10 | 3287 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also |
7 | 3288 ignores this option and closes all folds. |
3289 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to | |
3290 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files. | |
3291 When the value is negative, it is not used. | |
3292 | |
3293 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536* | |
3294 'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}") | |
3295 local to window | |
3296 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3297 feature} | |
3298 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There | |
3299 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The | |
3300 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow). | |
3301 See |fold-marker|. | |
3302 | |
3303 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'* | |
3304 'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual") | |
3305 local to window | |
3306 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3307 feature} | |
3308 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values: | |
3309 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually. | |
3310 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold. | |
3311 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line. | |
3312 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds. | |
3313 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds. | |
3314 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed. | |
3315 | |
3316 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'* | |
3317 'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1) | |
3318 local to window | |
3319 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3320 feature} | |
2709 | 3321 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed |
3322 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of | |
3323 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines. | |
3324 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line. | |
2826 | 3325 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using |
7 | 3326 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller |
3327 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold. | |
3328 | |
3329 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'* | |
3330 'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20) | |
3331 local to window | |
3332 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3333 feature} | |
3334 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax" | |
3335 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more | |
3336 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20. | |
3337 | |
3338 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'* | |
3339 'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix, | |
3340 search,tag,undo") | |
3341 global | |
3342 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3343 feature} | |
3344 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the | |
3345 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated | |
3346 list of items. | |
2625 | 3347 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used. |
3348 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect. | |
3349 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself) | |
3350 | |
7 | 3351 item commands ~ |
3352 all any | |
3353 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc. | |
3354 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc. | |
3355 insert any command in Insert mode | |
3356 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc. | |
3357 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc. | |
3358 percent "%" | |
3359 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc. | |
3360 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc. | |
3361 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command) | |
819 | 3362 Also for |[s| and |]s|. |
7 | 3363 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc. |
3364 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R | |
3365 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%") | |
3366 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the | |
3367 whole closed fold. | |
3368 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it | |
3369 very difficult to move onto a closed fold. | |
3370 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open | |
3371 when text is inserted. | |
3372 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or | |
3373 set the 'foldclose' option to "all". | |
3374 | |
3375 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'* | |
3376 'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()") | |
3377 local to window | |
3378 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| | |
3379 feature} | |
3380 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed | |
3381 fold. See |fold-foldtext|. | |
3382 | |
3682 | 3383 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a |
3384 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3385 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 3386 |
3387 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
3388 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|. | |
3389 | |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3390 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'* |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3391 'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "") |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3392 local to buffer |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3393 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3394 feature} |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3395 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3396 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3397 option is empty 'formatprg' is used. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3398 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3399 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3400 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3401 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3402 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3403 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3404 it yet! |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3405 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3406 Example: > |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3407 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format() |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3408 < This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3409 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload| |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3410 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3411 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3412 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3413 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3414 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3415 return "i" or "R" in this situation. |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
3416 |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3417 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3418 the internal format mechanism. |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3419 |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3420 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3421 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working, |
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3422 since changing the buffer text is not allowed. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3423 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
11160 | 3424 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
9286
64035abb986b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/c95a302a4c42ec8230473cd4a5e0064d0a143aa8
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9227
diff
changeset
|
3425 |
41 | 3426 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'* |
3427 'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*") | |
3428 local to buffer | |
3429 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for | |
3430 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'. | |
3431 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for | |
140 | 3432 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match |
41 | 3433 while still checking more characters. There must be a character |
3434 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled | |
3435 like there is no match. | |
3436 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation | |
3437 character and white space. | |
3438 | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3439 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'* |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3440 'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt") |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3441 local to buffer |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3442 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3443 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3444 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3445 be inserted for readability. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3446 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3447 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3448 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3449 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
3450 |
7 | 3451 *'formatprg'* *'fp'* |
3452 'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "") | |
10579
688b97124d23
patch 8.0.0179: cannot have a local value for 'formatprg'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10498
diff
changeset
|
3453 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 3454 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines |
667 | 3455 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on |
7 | 3456 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is |
557 | 3457 such a program. |
667 | 3458 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead. |
3459 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal | |
3460 format function will be used |C-indenting|. | |
557 | 3461 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
3462 about including spaces and backslashes. | |
3682 | 3463 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
3464 security reasons. | |
667 | 3465 |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
3466 *'fsync'* *'fs'* *'nofsync'* *'nofs'* |
36 | 3467 'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on) |
3468 global | |
3469 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a | |
3470 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely | |
3471 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This | |
3472 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop | |
3473 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that | |
3474 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On | |
3475 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always | |
3476 off. | |
3477 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files. | |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3478 'fsync' also applies to |writefile()|, unless a flag is used to |
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3479 overrule it. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3480 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3481 security reasons. |
36 | 3482 |
7 | 3483 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'* |
3484 'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off) | |
3485 global | |
3486 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that | |
3487 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag | |
3488 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution | |
3489 of all or one match. See |complex-change|. | |
3490 | |
3491 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~ | |
3492 :s/// subst. all subst. one | |
3493 :s///g subst. one subst. all | |
3494 :s///gg subst. all subst. one | |
3495 | |
3496 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
11516
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3497 DEPRECATED: Setting this option may break plugins that are not aware |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3498 of this option. Also, many users get confused that adding the /g flag |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3499 has the opposite effect of that it normally does. |
7 | 3500 |
3501 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'* | |
6213 | 3502 'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m") |
7 | 3503 global |
3504 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output. | |
3505 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the | |
3506 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|. | |
3507 | |
3508 *'grepprg'* *'gp'* | |
3509 'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ", | |
3510 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null", | |
3511 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n", | |
3512 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ") | |
3513 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
233 | 3514 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%' |
7 | 3515 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command- |
3516 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments | |
3517 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See | |
3518 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
3519 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep" | |
3520 also work well with a single file: > | |
3521 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH | |
161 | 3522 < Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command |
657 | 3523 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like |
3524 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|. | |
41 | 3525 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there |
7 | 3526 apply equally to 'grepprg'. |
3527 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found, | |
3528 otherwise it's "grep -n". | |
3529 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
3530 security reasons. | |
3531 | |
3532 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549* | |
3533 'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3534 ve:ver35-Cursor, | |
3535 o:hor50-Cursor, | |
3536 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3537 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor, | |
3538 sm:block-Cursor | |
3539 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175", | |
3540 for MS-DOS and Win32 console: | |
3541 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15, | |
3542 r-cr:hor30,sm:block") | |
3543 global | |
3544 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and | |
3545 for MS-DOS and Win32 console} | |
3546 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different | |
10 | 3547 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only |
7 | 3548 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by |
3549 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or | |
3550 horizontal cursor. | |
6727 | 3551 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are |
3552 used. | |
7 | 3553 |
10 | 3554 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a |
7 | 3555 mode-list and an argument-list: |
3556 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,.. | |
3557 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes: | |
3558 n Normal mode | |
3559 v Visual mode | |
3560 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v', | |
3561 if not specified) | |
3562 o Operator-pending mode | |
3563 i Insert mode | |
3564 r Replace mode | |
3565 c Command-line Normal (append) mode | |
3566 ci Command-line Insert mode | |
3567 cr Command-line Replace mode | |
3568 sm showmatch in Insert mode | |
3569 a all modes | |
3570 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments: | |
3571 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height | |
3572 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width | |
3573 block block cursor, fills the whole character | |
3574 [only one of the above three should be present] | |
3575 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking* | |
3576 blinkon{N} | |
3577 blinkoff{N} | |
3578 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before | |
3579 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that | |
3580 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the | |
3581 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one | |
3582 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The | |
3583 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250". | |
3584 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This | |
3585 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch | |
3586 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only | |
3587 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while | |
3588 executing a command. | |
3589 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see | |
3590 |xterm-blink|. | |
3591 {group-name} | |
3592 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font | |
3593 for the cursor | |
3594 {group-name}/{group-name} | |
3595 Two highlight group names, the first is used when | |
3596 no language mappings are used, the other when they | |
3597 are. |language-mapping| | |
3598 | |
3599 Examples of parts: | |
3600 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a | |
3601 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor" | |
3602 highlight group | |
3603 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150 | |
3604 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a | |
3605 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the | |
3606 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit | |
3607 faster. | |
3608 | |
3609 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for | |
3610 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used | |
3611 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off | |
3612 blinking: "a:blinkon0" | |
3613 | |
3614 Examples of cursor highlighting: > | |
3615 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE | |
3616 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg | |
3617 < | |
3618 *'guifont'* *'gfn'* | |
2908 | 3619 *E235* *E596* |
7 | 3620 'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "") |
3621 global | |
3622 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3623 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim. | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3624 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. |
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3625 See |gui-font| for the details. |
7 | 3626 |
3627 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'* | |
3628 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598* | |
3629 'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "") | |
3630 global | |
3631 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and | |
3632 with the |+xfontset| feature} | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
3633 {not available in the GTK+ GUI} |
7 | 3634 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first |
3635 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See | |
3636 |xfontset|. | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3637 |
7 | 3638 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534* |
3639 'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "") | |
3640 global | |
3641 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3642 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used | |
3643 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is | |
16439
9d20e26dc13c
patch 8.1.1224: MS-Windows: cannot specify font weight
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16427
diff
changeset
|
3644 used. See |gui-fontwide|. |
4055 | 3645 |
7 | 3646 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'* |
3647 'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50) | |
3648 global | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3649 {only for GTK and X11 GUI} |
7 | 3650 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting |
3651 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started, | |
3652 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will | |
10 | 3653 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel |
7 | 3654 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the |
3655 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the | |
3656 screen. | |
3657 | |
3658 *'guioptions'* *'go'* | |
14945 | 3659 'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows, |
3660 "t" is removed in |defaults.vim|), | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3661 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena), |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3662 ) |
7 | 3663 global |
3664 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
8 | 3665 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a |
7 | 3666 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the |
3667 GUI should be used. | |
3668 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the | |
3669 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|. | |
3670 | |
13470
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3671 Valid characters are as follows: |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3672 *'go-!'* |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3673 '!' External commands are executed in a terminal window. Without |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3674 this flag the MS-Windows GUI will open a console window to |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3675 execute the command. The Unix GUI will simulate a dumb |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3676 terminal to list the command output. |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3677 The terminal window will be positioned at the bottom, and grow |
6faef782f50b
patch 8.0.1609: shell commands in the GUI use a dumb terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13437
diff
changeset
|
3678 upwards as needed. |
14999 | 3679 *'go-a'* |
7 | 3680 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started, |
3681 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of | |
3682 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the | |
3683 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other | |
3684 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode | |
3685 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an | |
3686 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text | |
3687 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register. | |
3688 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other | |
3689 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended. | |
3690 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the | |
3691 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to | |
3692 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register. | |
3693 The same applies to the modeless selection. | |
3674 | 3694 *'go-P'* |
3695 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "* | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
3696 register. |
1152 | 3697 *'go-A'* |
10 | 3698 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only |
7 | 3699 applies to the modeless selection. |
3700 | |
3701 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~ | |
3702 "" - - | |
3703 "a" yes yes | |
3704 "A" - yes | |
3705 "aA" yes yes | |
3706 | |
1152 | 3707 *'go-c'* |
7 | 3708 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple |
3709 choices. | |
1152 | 3710 *'go-e'* |
697 | 3711 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'. |
688 | 3712 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels. |
3713 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used. | |
857 | 3714 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently |
1621 | 3715 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows. |
1152 | 3716 *'go-f'* |
7 | 3717 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell |
3718 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the | |
3719 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you | |
3720 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the | |
3721 foreground. |gui-fork| | |
3722 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have | |
819 | 3723 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read. |
1152 | 3724 *'go-i'* |
7 | 3725 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper |
3726 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of | |
3727 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3728 *'go-m'* |
7 | 3729 'm' Menu bar is present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3730 *'go-M'* |
10 | 3731 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note |
7 | 3732 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before |
819 | 3733 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc| |
7 | 3734 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
3735 `:syntax on` and `:filetype on` commands load the menu too). |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3736 *'go-g'* |
7 | 3737 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If |
3738 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all. | |
3739 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items. | |
1152 | 3740 *'go-t'* |
7 | 3741 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32, |
3742 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI. | |
1152 | 3743 *'go-T'* |
236 | 3744 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon |
856 | 3745 and Athena GUIs. |
1152 | 3746 *'go-r'* |
7 | 3747 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3748 *'go-R'* |
7 | 3749 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically |
3750 split window. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3751 *'go-l'* |
7 | 3752 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3753 *'go-L'* |
7 | 3754 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically |
3755 split window. | |
1152 | 3756 *'go-b'* |
7 | 3757 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on |
3758 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h' | |
3759 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll| | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3760 *'go-h'* |
7 | 3761 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor |
3762 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll| | |
3763 | |
3764 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if | |
3765 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information. | |
3766 | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3767 *'go-v'* |
7 | 3768 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included, |
3769 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a | |
3770 vertical layout is used anyway. | |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3771 *'go-p'* |
7 | 3772 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some |
3773 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at | |
3774 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done | |
819 | 3775 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or |
7 | 3776 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect. |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
3777 *'go-F'* |
10 | 3778 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|. |
12802
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3779 *'go-k'* |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3780 'k' Keep the GUI window size when adding/removing a scrollbar, or |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3781 toolbar, tabline, etc. Instead, the behavior is similar to |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3782 when the window is maximized and will adjust 'lines' and |
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3783 'columns' to fit to the window. Without the 'k' flag Vim will |
12865
ebb4f6c93598
patch 8.0.1309: cannot use 'balloonexpr' in a terminal
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12826
diff
changeset
|
3784 try to keep 'lines' and 'columns' the same when adding and |
12802
29a728529f92
patch 8.0.1278: GUI window always resizes when adding scrollbar
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12785
diff
changeset
|
3785 removing GUI components. |
1152 | 3786 |
7 | 3787 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'* |
3788 'guipty' boolean (default on) | |
3789 global | |
3790 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled} | |
3791 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for | |
3792 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|. | |
3793 | |
688 | 3794 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'* |
3795 'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty) | |
3796 global | |
692 | 3797 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3798 with the |+windows| feature} |
688 | 3799 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab |
857 | 3800 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a |
3801 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info. | |
688 | 3802 |
692 | 3803 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'. |
839 | 3804 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below. |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
3805 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
3806 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
3807 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
692 | 3808 |
688 | 3809 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be |
3810 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is | |
3811 used. | |
3812 | |
839 | 3813 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'* |
3814 'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty) | |
3815 global | |
3816 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3817 with the |+windows| feature} |
839 | 3818 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab |
3819 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip. | |
3820 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3821 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3822 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two" |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
3823 < |
839 | 3824 |
7 | 3825 *'helpfile'* *'hf'* |
3826 'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt" | |
3827 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt") | |
3828 global | |
3829 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be | |
3830 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories | |
3831 in 'runtimepath' will be used. | |
3832 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example: | |
3833 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also | |
10 | 3834 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including |
7 | 3835 spaces and backslashes. |
3836 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
3837 security reasons. | |
3838 | |
3839 *'helpheight'* *'hh'* | |
3840 'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20) | |
3841 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
3842 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 3843 feature} |
3844 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the | |
3845 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the | |
3846 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other | |
3847 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is | |
3848 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable. | |
3849 | |
3850 *'helplang'* *'hlg'* | |
3851 'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty) | |
3852 global | |
3853 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang| | |
3854 feature} | |
3855 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language | |
3856 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always | |
3857 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over | |
3858 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that | |
3859 language and not in the English help. | |
3860 Example: > | |
3861 :set helplang=de,it | |
3862 < This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help | |
3863 files. | |
3864 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will | |
3865 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option. | |
3866 See |help-translated|. | |
3867 | |
3868 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'* | |
3869 'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off) | |
3870 global | |
3871 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a | |
3872 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still | |
3873 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course. | |
3874 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer | |
3875 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is | |
3876 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!' | |
10 | 3877 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|. |
12 | 3878 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option. |
7 | 3879 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|. |
3880 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers. | |
3881 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!". | |
3882 | |
3883 *'highlight'* *'hl'* | |
3884 'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string): | |
9877
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3885 "8:SpecialKey,~:EndOfBuffer,@:NonText, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3886 d:Directory,e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3887 l:Search,m:MoreMsg,M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3888 N:CursorLineNr,r:Question,s:StatusLine, |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3889 S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,t:Title, |
15194 | 3890 v:Visual,V:VisualNOS,w:WarningMsg, |
3891 W:WildMenu,f:Folded,F:FoldColumn, | |
3892 A:DiffAdd,C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete, | |
3893 T:DiffText,>:SignColumn,-:Conceal, | |
15281 | 3894 B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,R:SpellRare, |
15194 | 3895 L:SpellLocal,+:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel, |
11516
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3896 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb,*:TabLine, |
80491a71c716
patch 8.0.0641: cannot set a separate highlighting for the quickfix line
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11473
diff
changeset
|
3897 #:TabLineSel,_:TabLineFill,!:CursorColumn, |
11914 | 3898 .:CursorLine,o:ColorColumn,q:QuickFixLine, |
12254 | 3899 z:StatusLineTerm,Z:StatusLineTermNC") |
7 | 3900 global |
3901 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various | |
3902 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The | |
3903 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to | |
10 | 3904 use for that occasion. The occasions are: |
7 | 3905 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map" |
9877
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3906 |hl-EndOfBuffer| ~ lines after the last line in the buffer |
7da89d9c744b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/58b853460add42098ab08017df9e030fb14fd34b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9860
diff
changeset
|
3907 |hl-NonText| @ '@' at the end of the window and |
7 | 3908 characters from 'showbreak' |
3909 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special | |
3910 things in listings | |
3911 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages | |
3912 h (obsolete, ignored) | |
3913 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting | |
3914 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch') | |
3915 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt| | |
3916 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --") | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3917 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
3918 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set. |
4073 | 3919 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is |
3920 set. | |
7 | 3921 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions |
3922 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line| | |
12785 | 3923 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows |
7 | 3924 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc. |
3925 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows | |
3926 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode | |
3927 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the | |
3928 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and | |
3929 |xterm-clipboard|. | |
3930 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages | |
3931 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu' | |
3932 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds | |
3933 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn' | |
386 | 3934 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode |
3935 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode | |
3936 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode | |
3937 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode | |
7 | 3938 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs| |
15194 | 3939 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters |
3940 (see 'conceallevel') | |
221 | 3941 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell| |
2337
a0f87fc19d1d
Better conceal in help. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2324
diff
changeset
|
3942 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell| |
221 | 3943 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell| |
3944 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell| | |
15194 | 3945 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line |
3946 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu selected line | |
3947 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar | |
3948 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb | |
7 | 3949 |
3950 The display modes are: | |
3951 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me") | |
3952 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR") | |
3953 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me") | |
3954 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se") | |
3955 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue") | |
205 | 3956 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce") |
12317
2a8890b80923
patch 8.0.1038: strike-through text not supported
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12293
diff
changeset
|
3957 t strikethrough (termcap entry "Ts" and "Te") |
7 | 3958 n no highlighting |
3959 - no highlighting | |
3960 : use a highlight group | |
3961 The default is used for occasions that are not included. | |
3962 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors| | |
3963 for an example. | |
3964 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of | |
3965 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type | |
3966 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to | |
3967 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion. | |
3968 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups. | |
3969 | |
3970 *'history'* *'hi'* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3971 'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0, |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
3972 set to 200 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 3973 global |
3974 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns | |
5991 | 3975 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in |
7 | 3976 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|). |
5991 | 3977 The maximum value is 10000. |
7 | 3978 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
3979 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
3980 | |
3981 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'* | |
3982 'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off) | |
3983 global | |
3984 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3985 feature} | |
3986 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set. | |
3987 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to | |
3988 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|. | |
3989 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
3990 | |
3991 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'* | |
3992 'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off) | |
3993 global | |
3994 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
3995 feature} | |
3996 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on. | |
3997 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard. | |
3998 See |rileft.txt|. | |
3999 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4000 | |
11160 | 4001 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'* |
4002 'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off) | |
4003 global | |
4004 {not available when compiled without the | |
4005 |+extra_search| feature} | |
4006 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches. | |
4007 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the | |
4008 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by | |
4009 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets | |
4010 are not applied. | |
4011 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|. | |
4012 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it | |
4013 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as | |
4014 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back. | |
4015 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches. | |
4016 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to | |
4017 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the | |
4018 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first | |
4019 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not | |
4020 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line. | |
4021 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup | |
4022 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|. | |
4023 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4024 | |
7 | 4025 *'icon'* *'noicon'* |
4026 'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored) | |
4027 global | |
4028 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
4029 feature} | |
4030 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of | |
4031 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file | |
4032 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used. | |
4033 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option. | |
4034 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently | |
4035 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are | |
4036 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the | |
4037 builtin termcap). | |
4038 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be | |
233 | 4039 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on |
7 | 4040 X11. |
6259 | 4041 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|. |
7 | 4042 |
4043 *'iconstring'* | |
4044 'iconstring' string (default "") | |
4045 global | |
4046 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
4047 feature} | |
4048 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of | |
4049 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on. | |
4050 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text | |
4051 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option). | |
4052 Does not work for MS Windows. | |
4053 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be | |
4054 restored if possible |X11|. | |
4055 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be | |
10 | 4056 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See |
7 | 4057 'titlestring' for example settings. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4058 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
7 | 4059 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature} |
4060 | |
4061 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'* | |
4062 'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off) | |
4063 global | |
4064 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags | |
4065 file. | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
4066 Also see 'smartcase' and 'tagcase'. |
7 | 4067 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see |
4068 |/ignorecase|. | |
4069 | |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4070 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'* |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4071 'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "") |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4072 global |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4073 This option specifies a function that will be called to |
12936
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4074 activate or deactivate the Input Method. |
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4075 It is not used in the GUI. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4076 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4077 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4078 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4079 Example: > |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4080 function ImActivateFunc(active) |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4081 if a:active |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4082 ... do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4083 else |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4084 ... do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4085 endif |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4086 " return value is not used |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4087 endfunction |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4088 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4089 < |
7 | 4090 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'* |
4091 'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "") | |
4092 global | |
4093 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and | |
2209
d0ddf7ba1630
Included the patch to support netbeans in a terminal.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2207
diff
changeset
|
4094 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599* |
7 | 4095 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for |
4096 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control | |
4097 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'. | |
4098 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option | |
4099 tells Vim what the key is. | |
4100 Format: | |
4101 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING | |
4102 | |
4103 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored): | |
4104 S Shift key | |
4105 L Lock key | |
4106 C Control key | |
4107 1 Mod1 key | |
4108 2 Mod2 key | |
4109 3 Mod3 key | |
4110 4 Mod4 key | |
4111 5 Mod5 key | |
4112 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are | |
4113 both shift+ctrl+space. | |
4114 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING. | |
4115 | |
4116 Example: > | |
4117 :set imactivatekey=S-space | |
4118 < "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 + | |
4119 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean). | |
4120 | |
4121 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'* | |
4122 'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off) | |
4123 global | |
4124 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command | |
4125 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that). | |
4126 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering | |
4127 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented | |
4128 characters with dead keys. | |
4129 | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4130 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'* |
7 | 4131 'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI)) |
4132 global | |
4133 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable | |
4134 the IM when it doesn't work properly. | |
4135 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This | |
4136 may change in later releases. | |
4137 | |
4138 *'iminsert'* *'imi'* | |
12469
61d910f0999d
patch 8.0.1114: default for 'iminsert' is annoying
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12317
diff
changeset
|
4139 'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0) |
7 | 4140 local to buffer |
4141 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in | |
4142 Insert mode. Valid values: | |
4143 0 :lmap is off and IM is off | |
4144 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off | |
4145 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON | |
4146 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc> | |
4147 this can be used: > | |
4148 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR> | |
4149 < This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert | |
4150 mode. | |
4151 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode | |
4152 |i_CTRL-^|. | |
4153 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name. | |
4154 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f". | |
4155 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM | |
4156 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then. | |
4157 | |
12920
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4158 You can set 'imactivatefunc' and 'imstatusfunc' to handle IME/XIM |
14519 | 4159 via external command if Vim is not compiled with the |+xim|, |
12920
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4160 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime|. |
327e1264b9bf
patch 8.0.1336: cannot use imactivatefunc() unless compiled with +xim
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12865
diff
changeset
|
4161 |
7 | 4162 *'imsearch'* *'ims'* |
12469
61d910f0999d
patch 8.0.1114: default for 'iminsert' is annoying
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12317
diff
changeset
|
4163 'imsearch' 'ims' number (default -1) |
7 | 4164 local to buffer |
4165 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when | |
4166 entering a search pattern. Valid values: | |
4167 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like | |
4168 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern | |
4169 0 :lmap is off and IM is off | |
4170 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off | |
4171 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON | |
4172 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode | |
4173 |c_CTRL-^|. | |
4174 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap' | |
4175 option to a valid keymap name. | |
4176 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM | |
4177 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then. | |
4178 | |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4179 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'* |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4180 'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "") |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4181 global |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4182 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4183 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active. |
12936
c53a80f39a52
patch 8.0.1344: using 'imactivatefunc' in the GUI does not work
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12934
diff
changeset
|
4184 It is not used in the GUI. |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4185 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4186 Example: > |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4187 function ImStatusFunc() |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4188 let is_active = ...do something |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4189 return is_active ? 1 : 0 |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4190 endfunction |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4191 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4192 < |
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4193 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4194 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4195 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
5008
3717d569027d
updated for version 7.3.1248
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4869
diff
changeset
|
4196 |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4197 *'imstyle'* *'imst'* |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4198 'imstyle' 'imst' number (default 1) |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4199 global |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4200 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4201 |+GUI_GTK|} |
12499 | 4202 This option specifies the input style of Input Method: |
4203 0 use on-the-spot style | |
4204 1 over-the-spot style | |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4205 See: |xim-input-style| |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4206 |
12559 | 4207 For a long time on-the-spot style had been used in the GTK version of |
4208 vim, however, it is known that it causes troubles when using mappings, | |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4209 |single-repeat|, etc. Therefore over-the-spot style becomes the |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4210 default now. This should work fine for most people, however if you |
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4211 have any problem with it, try using on-the-spot style. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4212 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4213 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. |
12293
1ff5e5dfa9b0
patch 8.0.1026: GTK on-the-spot input has problems
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12254
diff
changeset
|
4214 |
7 | 4215 *'include'* *'inc'* |
4216 'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include") | |
4217 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
4218 {not available when compiled without the | |
4219 |+find_in_path| feature} | |
10 | 4220 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search |
7 | 4221 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default |
4222 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i", | |
532 | 4223 "]I", "[d", etc. |
4224 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that | |
534 | 4225 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern |
4226 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it | |
4227 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters | |
4228 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use | |
4229 'includeexpr' to process the matched text. | |
532 | 4230 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
7 | 4231 |
4232 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'* | |
4233 'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "") | |
4234 local to buffer | |
4235 {not available when compiled without the | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4236 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features} |
7 | 4237 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include' |
10 | 4238 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: > |
7 | 4239 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g') |
4240 < The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected. | |
634 | 4241 |
7 | 4242 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be |
10 | 4243 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement. |
7 | 4244 Also used for |<cfile>|. |
4245 | |
3682 | 4246 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
4247 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4248 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 4249 |
4250 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
4251 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|. | |
4252 | |
7 | 4253 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4254 'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim| if the |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4255 +reltime feature is supported) |
7 | 4256 global |
4257 {not available when compiled without the | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4258 |+extra_search| features} |
17 | 4259 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed |
4260 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern | |
4261 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated | |
4262 often, this is only useful on fast terminals. | |
14637 | 4263 Also applies to the pattern in commands: > |
4264 :global | |
4265 :lvimgrep | |
4266 :lvimgrepadd | |
4267 :smagic | |
4268 :snomagic | |
4269 :sort | |
4270 :substitute | |
4271 :vglobal | |
4272 :vimgrep | |
4273 :vimgrepadd | |
4274 < Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its | |
17 | 4275 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You |
4276 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the | |
4277 cursor to the match. | |
10261
bdd7fc1a38c0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc08328821a2c11e33dfb1980332e4923ec64fca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10244
diff
changeset
|
4278 You can use the CTRL-G and CTRL-T keys to move to the next and |
bdd7fc1a38c0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc08328821a2c11e33dfb1980332e4923ec64fca
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10244
diff
changeset
|
4279 previous match. |c_CTRL-G| |c_CTRL-T| |
1521 | 4280 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about |
4281 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the | |
4282 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you | |
4283 are typing the pattern. | |
17 | 4284 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'. |
12968 | 4285 When 'hlsearch' is on, all matched strings are highlighted too while |
4286 typing a search command. See also: 'hlsearch'. | |
14519 | 4287 If you don't want to turn 'hlsearch' on, but want to highlight all |
4288 matches while searching, you can turn on and off 'hlsearch' with | |
4289 autocmd. Example: > | |
12720
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4290 augroup vimrc-incsearch-highlight |
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4291 autocmd! |
12744
0c704288ced4
patch 8.0.1250: 'hlsearch' highlighting not removed after incsearch
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12720
diff
changeset
|
4292 autocmd CmdlineEnter /,\? :set hlsearch |
0c704288ced4
patch 8.0.1250: 'hlsearch' highlighting not removed after incsearch
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12720
diff
changeset
|
4293 autocmd CmdlineLeave /,\? :set nohlsearch |
12720
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4294 augroup END |
37c384802df4
patch 8.0.1238: incremental search only shows one match
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12608
diff
changeset
|
4295 < |
772 | 4296 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match |
2302
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4297 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the |
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4298 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is |
488be8cbe19c
Make CTRL-L in command line mode respect 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase'. (Martin
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2301
diff
changeset
|
4299 converted to lowercase. |
772 | 4300 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current |
4301 match, excluding the characters that were already typed. | |
7 | 4302 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
4303 | |
4304 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'* | |
4305 'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "") | |
4306 local to buffer | |
4307 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
4308 or |+eval| features} | |
4309 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line. | |
4310 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and | |
4311 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option. | |
4312 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and | |
2833 | 4313 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is |
4314 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm. | |
7 | 4315 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting. |
4316 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for | |
534 | 4317 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line |
7 | 4318 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around). |
4319 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It | |
4320 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is | |
4321 used for the indent). | |
4322 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()| | |
4323 and |lispindent()|. | |
4324 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must | |
4325 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the | |
4326 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved. | |
4327 Normally this option would be set to call a function: > | |
4328 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent() | |
4329 < Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains | |
4330 "msg". | |
634 | 4331 See |indent-expression|. |
11160 | 4332 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 4333 |
3682 | 4334 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a |
4335 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
4336 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 4337 |
4338 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
4339 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|. | |
4340 | |
4341 | |
7 | 4342 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'* |
15701
9cd11f6beb70
patch 8.1.0858: 'indentkeys' and 'cinkeys' defaults are different
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15512
diff
changeset
|
4343 'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e") |
7 | 4344 local to buffer |
4345 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent| | |
4346 feature} | |
4347 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of | |
4348 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty. | |
4349 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|. | |
4350 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|. | |
4351 | |
4352 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'* | |
4353 'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off) | |
4354 local to buffer | |
4355 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and | |
1621 | 4356 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending |
4357 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter | |
4358 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made | |
4359 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match | |
4360 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter, | |
4361 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase. | |
4362 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is. | |
7 | 4363 |
4364 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'* | |
4365 'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off) | |
4366 global | |
4367 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful | |
4368 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|. | |
4369 These Insert mode commands will be useful: | |
4370 - Use the cursor keys to move around. | |
9887
b4da19b7539f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc1f1645cb495fa6bfbe216d7359f23539a0e25d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9877
diff
changeset
|
4371 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|. When |
7 | 4372 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off. |
4373 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished. | |
4374 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use | |
477 | 4375 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor |
4376 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L| | |
7 | 4377 |
4378 These items change when 'insertmode' is set: | |
4379 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode. | |
4380 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps. | |
4381 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode. | |
4382 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted. | |
4383 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z* | |
4384 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like | |
4385 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same | |
4386 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set. | |
4387 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used. | |
4388 | |
4389 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
4390 | |
4391 *'isfname'* *'isf'* | |
4392 'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: | |
4393 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,=" | |
4394 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:" | |
4395 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~" | |
4396 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=" | |
4397 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=") | |
4398 global | |
4399 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and | |
4400 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in | |
10 | 4401 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|. |
7 | 4402 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the |
4403 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. | |
4404 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well. | |
1621 | 4405 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a |
4406 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim | |
4407 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion. | |
4408 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'. | |
7 | 4409 |
4410 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to | |
4411 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit | |
4412 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special | |
4413 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file | |
4414 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The | |
4415 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for | |
4416 cmd.exe. | |
4417 | |
4418 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas. | |
10 | 4419 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two |
4420 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a | |
7 | 4421 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does |
4422 not work for digits). Example: | |
4423 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range | |
4424 128 to 140 and '#' to 43) | |
4425 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range | |
4426 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left | |
4427 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is | |
4428 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the | |
4429 option or the end of a range. Example: | |
4430 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^') | |
4431 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE | |
4432 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z, | |
4433 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples: | |
4434 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower | |
1621 | 4435 case ASCII letters. |
7 | 4436 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character. |
4437 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is | |
4438 expected. Example: | |
4439 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore. | |
4440 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example: | |
4441 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding | |
4442 comma, plus <Tab>. | |
4443 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4444 | |
4445 *'isident'* *'isi'* | |
4446 'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: | |
4447 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235" | |
4448 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255") | |
4449 global | |
4450 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers. | |
4451 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a | |
4452 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a | |
233 | 4453 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this |
14864 | 4454 option. For '@' only characters up to 255 are used. |
7 | 4455 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding |
10 | 4456 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to |
7 | 4457 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead. |
4458 | |
4459 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'* | |
4460 'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32: | |
4461 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235" | |
4462 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255" | |
4463 Vi default: "@,48-57,_") | |
4464 local to buffer | |
4465 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands: | |
10 | 4466 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See |
14864 | 4467 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For '@' |
4468 characters above 255 check the "word" character class. | |
4469 For C programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>". | |
7 | 4470 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except |
4471 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that | |
4472 command). | |
4473 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included. | |
7687
61354fabf8a2
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b8060fe862f684b591f9ac679eac5b2594d6c5a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7538
diff
changeset
|
4474 This option also influences syntax highlighting, unless the syntax |
61354fabf8a2
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b8060fe862f684b591f9ac679eac5b2594d6c5a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7538
diff
changeset
|
4475 uses |:syn-iskeyword|. |
7 | 4476 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
4477 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
4478 | |
4479 *'isprint'* *'isp'* | |
4480 'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh: | |
4481 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255") | |
4482 global | |
4483 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the | |
4484 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from | |
4485 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly, | |
4486 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See | |
4487 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. | |
4488 | |
4489 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters: | |
4490 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_" | |
4491 32 - 126 always single characters | |
4492 127 "^?" | |
4493 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_" | |
4494 160 - 254 "| " - "|~" | |
4495 255 "~?" | |
4496 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are | |
4497 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte. | |
4498 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are | |
4499 displayed as <xx>. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4500 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4501 |hl-SpecialKey| |
7 | 4502 |
4503 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the | |
4504 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character | |
4505 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a | |
4506 replacement character will be shown. | |
4507 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>. | |
4508 There is no option to specify these characters. | |
4509 | |
4510 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'* | |
4511 'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on) | |
4512 global | |
4513 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command. | |
4514 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'. | |
4515 Otherwise only one space is inserted. | |
4516 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. | |
4517 | |
4518 *'key'* | |
4519 'key' string (default "") | |
4520 local to buffer | |
2283
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2265
diff
changeset
|
4521 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv| |
7e1bd501306d
Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2265
diff
changeset
|
4522 feature} |
7 | 4523 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer. |
2180
f60a0c9cbe6c
Add the blowfish encryption patch from Mohsin Ahmed. Needs more work.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2178
diff
changeset
|
4524 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'. |
7 | 4525 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed |
4526 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: > | |
4527 :set key= | |
4528 < It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or | |
4529 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't | |
4530 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it, | |
4531 be careful not to make a typing error! | |
2698
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4532 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is |
b6471224d2af
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2681
diff
changeset
|
4533 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars). |
7 | 4534 |
4535 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544* | |
4536 'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "") | |
4537 local to buffer | |
4538 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap| | |
4539 feature} | |
4540 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|. | |
4541 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of | |
4542 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective. | |
4543 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1 | |
36 | 4544 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 4545 |
4546 *'keymodel'* *'km'* | |
4547 'keymodel' 'km' string (default "") | |
4548 global | |
4549 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys | |
4550 can do. These values can be used: | |
4551 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either | |
4552 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being | |
4553 present in 'selectmode'). | |
4554 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection. | |
4555 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>, | |
4556 <PageUp> and <PageDown>. | |
4557 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
4558 | |
4559 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'* | |
4560 'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help", | |
9098
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4561 VMS: "help") |
7 | 4562 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
4563 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are | |
4564 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal | |
4565 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty | |
4566 value did this, which is now deprecated.) | |
9098
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4567 When the first character is ":", the command is invoked as a Vim |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4568 Ex command prefixed with [count]. |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4569 When "man", "man -s" or an Ex command is used, Vim will automatically |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4570 translate a count for the "K" command and pass it as the first |
0d52ddff8db4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/2ff8b64679242e73248774a388d54931c9ce49bd
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9097
diff
changeset
|
4571 argument. For "man -s" the "-s" is removed when there is no count. |
7 | 4572 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
4573 Example: > | |
4574 :set keywordprg=man\ -s | |
4575 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4576 security reasons. | |
4577 | |
4578 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358* | |
4579 'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "") | |
4580 global | |
4581 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| | |
4582 feature} | |
4583 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language | |
10 | 4584 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
4585 inserted directly. When in Normal mode the 'langmap' option takes |
7 | 4586 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning |
4587 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to | |
4588 be able to execute Normal mode commands. | |
4589 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are | |
4590 mapped in Insert mode. | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4591 Also consider resetting 'langremap' to avoid 'langmap' applies to |
6369 | 4592 characters resulting from a mapping. |
5908 | 4593 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
4594 security reasons. | |
7 | 4595 |
699 | 4596 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* > |
4597 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz | |
7 | 4598 < Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): > |
4599 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ | |
4600 < | |
4601 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each | |
4602 part can be in one of two forms: | |
4603 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately | |
4604 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC". | |
4605 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to" | |
4606 characters. Example: "abc;ABC" | |
4607 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE" | |
4608 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are | |
4609 ";", ',' and backslash itself. | |
4610 | |
4611 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch | |
4612 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will | |
4613 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the | |
4614 langmap mappings) in the following cases: | |
4615 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings) | |
4616 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R | |
4617 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings | |
4618 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by | |
4619 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time | |
4620 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings. | |
4621 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time! | |
4622 | |
4623 *'langmenu'* *'lm'* | |
4624 'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "") | |
4625 global | |
4626 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and | |
4627 |+multi_lang| features} | |
4628 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded | |
4629 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': > | |
4630 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim" | |
4631 < (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no | |
4632 matter what $LANG is set to: > | |
4633 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1 | |
4634 < When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used. | |
36 | 4635 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 4636 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use |
4637 the English menus: > | |
4638 :set langmenu=none | |
4639 < This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype | |
4640 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting | |
4641 this option has no effect. But you could do this: > | |
4642 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim | |
4643 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1 | |
4644 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim | |
4645 < Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself! | |
4646 | |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4647 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'* *'nolangnoremap'* *'nolnr'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
4648 'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
6339 | 4649 global |
4650 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| | |
4651 feature} | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4652 This is just like 'langremap' but with the value inverted. It only |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4653 exists for backwards compatibility. When setting 'langremap' then |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4654 'langnoremap' is set to the inverted value, and the other way around. |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4655 |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4656 *'langremap'* *'lrm'* *'nolangremap'* *'nolrm'* |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4657 'langremap' 'lrm' boolean (default on, reset in |defaults.vim|) |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4658 global |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4659 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap| |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4660 feature} |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4661 When off, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from |
6339 | 4662 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4663 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try resetting this option. |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
4664 This option defaults to on for backwards compatibility. Set it off if |
6339 | 4665 that works for you to avoid mappings to break. |
4666 | |
7 | 4667 *'laststatus'* *'ls'* |
4668 'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1) | |
4669 global | |
4670 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a | |
4671 status line: | |
4672 0: never | |
4673 1: only if there are at least two windows | |
4674 2: always | |
4675 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several | |
4676 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line| | |
4677 | |
4678 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'* | |
4679 'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off) | |
4680 global | |
4681 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while | |
4682 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been | |
10 | 4683 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an |
7 | 4684 update use |:redraw|. |
4685 | |
4686 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'* | |
4687 'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off) | |
4688 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4689 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 4690 feature} |
6009 | 4691 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather |
7 | 4692 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike |
4693 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file, | |
6009 | 4694 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. |
4695 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value | |
4696 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option | |
6026 | 4697 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off. |
7 | 4698 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed |
4699 with the right amount of white space. | |
4700 | |
4701 *'lines'* *E593* | |
4702 'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height) | |
4703 global | |
4704 Number of lines of the Vim window. | |
4705 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the | |
161 | 4706 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|. |
7 | 4707 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this |
4708 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want | |
4709 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file. | |
4710 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can | |
4711 use this command to get the tallest window possible: > | |
4712 :set lines=999 | |
571 | 4713 < Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000. |
9887
b4da19b7539f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/dc1f1645cb495fa6bfbe216d7359f23539a0e25d
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9877
diff
changeset
|
4714 If you get fewer lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option. |
7 | 4715 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical |
4716 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up. | |
4717 | |
4718 *'linespace'* *'lsp'* | |
4719 'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI) | |
4720 global | |
4721 {only in the GUI} | |
4722 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font | |
4723 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other. | |
4724 When non-zero there is room for underlining. | |
180 | 4725 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have |
4726 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set | |
4727 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems | |
4728 though! | |
7 | 4729 |
4730 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'* | |
4731 'lisp' boolean (default off) | |
4732 local to buffer | |
4733 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent| | |
4734 feature} | |
4735 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for | |
4736 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with | |
4737 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p' | |
4738 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or | |
4739 better. Also see 'lispwords'. | |
4740 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the | |
4741 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than | |
4742 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty. | |
4743 This option is not used when 'paste' is set. | |
4744 | |
4745 *'lispwords'* *'lw'* | |
4746 'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long) | |
5712 | 4747 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 4748 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent| |
4749 feature} | |
4750 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting. | |
4751 |'lisp'| | |
4752 | |
4753 *'list'* *'nolist'* | |
4754 'list' boolean (default off) | |
4755 local to window | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4756 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4757 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4758 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4759 |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4760 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4761 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4762 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: > |
5161
f7add3891e95
Updated runtime files. Fix NL translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
5146
diff
changeset
|
4763 :set list lcs=tab:\ \ |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4764 < |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4765 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth' |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
4766 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for |
7 | 4767 changing the way tabs are displayed. |
4768 | |
4769 *'listchars'* *'lcs'* | |
4770 'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$") | |
4771 global | |
2458 | 4772 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a |
4773 comma separated list of string settings. | |
6777 | 4774 *lcs-eol* |
7 | 4775 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When |
4776 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the | |
4777 line. | |
6777 | 4778 *lcs-tab* |
15502
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4779 tab:xy[z] Two or three characters to be used to show a tab. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4780 The third character is optional. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4781 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4782 tab:xy The 'x' is always used, then 'y' as many times as will |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4783 fit. Thus "tab:>-" displays: |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4784 > |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4785 >- |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4786 >-- |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4787 etc. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4788 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4789 tab:xyz The 'z' is always used, then 'x' is prepended, and |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4790 then 'y' is used as many times as will fit. Thus |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4791 "tab:<->" displays: |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4792 > |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4793 <> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4794 <-> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4795 <--> |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4796 etc. |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4797 |
bc17a9d37810
patch 8.1.0759: showing two characters for tab is limited
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15396
diff
changeset
|
4798 When "tab:" is omitted, a tab is shown as ^I. |
6777 | 4799 *lcs-space* |
4800 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces | |
4801 are left blank. | |
4802 *lcs-trail* | |
10 | 4803 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted, |
6777 | 4804 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" |
4805 setting for trailing spaces. | |
4806 *lcs-extends* | |
7 | 4807 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is |
4808 off and the line continues beyond the right of the | |
4809 screen. | |
6777 | 4810 *lcs-precedes* |
7 | 4811 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap' |
4812 is off and there is text preceding the character | |
4813 visible in the first column. | |
6777 | 4814 *lcs-conceal* |
2250
1bac28a53fae
Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2249
diff
changeset
|
4815 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
4816 'conceallevel' is set to 1. |
6777 | 4817 *lcs-nbsp* |
6801 | 4818 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space character |
4819 (0xA0 (160 decimal) and U+202F). Left blank when | |
4820 omitted. | |
7 | 4821 |
10 | 4822 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can |
7 | 4823 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable |
819 | 4824 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width. |
7 | 4825 |
4826 Examples: > | |
4827 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:- | |
12 | 4828 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:% |
7 | 4829 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:< |
4830 < The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and | |
6777 | 4831 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "space", "tab" and "trail". |
1152 | 4832 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey| |
7 | 4833 |
4834 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'* | |
4835 'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on) | |
4836 global | |
4837 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|. | |
4838 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading | |
4839 of plugins. | |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
4840 Note that using the "-u NONE", "-u DEFAULTS" and "--noplugin" command |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
4841 line arguments reset this option. See |-u| and |--noplugin|. |
7 | 4842 |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4843 *'luadll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
4844 'luadll' string (default depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4845 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4846 {only available when compiled with the |+lua/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4847 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4848 Specifies the name of the Lua shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
4849 DYNAMIC_LUA_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
4850 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4851 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4852 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
4853 |
842 | 4854 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'* |
4855 'macatsui' boolean (default on) | |
4856 global | |
4857 {only available in Mac GUI version} | |
4858 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set | |
4859 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When | |
4860 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when | |
4861 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may | |
4862 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method | |
4863 to unset it: > | |
4864 if exists('&macatsui') | |
4865 set nomacatsui | |
4866 endif | |
1152 | 4867 < Another option to check if you have drawing problems is |
4868 'termencoding'. | |
4869 | |
7 | 4870 *'magic'* *'nomagic'* |
4871 'magic' boolean (default on) | |
4872 global | |
4873 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns. | |
4874 See |pattern|. | |
10140
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4875 WARNING: Switching this option off most likely breaks plugins! That |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4876 is because many patterns assume it's on and will fail when it's off. |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4877 Only switch it off when working with old Vi scripts. In any other |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4878 situation write patterns that work when 'magic' is on. Include "\M" |
b11ceef7116e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/64d8e25bf6efe5f18b032563521c3ce278c316ab
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10027
diff
changeset
|
4879 when you want to |/\M|. |
7 | 4880 |
4881 *'makeef'* *'mef'* | |
4882 'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "") | |
4883 global | |
4884 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
4885 feature} | |
4886 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|) | |
4887 and the |:grep| command. | |
4888 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used. | |
4889 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name | |
4890 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an | |
4891 existing file. | |
4892 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that. | |
4893 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
4894 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4895 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4896 security reasons. | |
4897 | |
11063
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4898 *'makeencoding'* *'menc'* |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4899 'makeencoding' 'menc' string (default "") |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4900 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4901 Encoding used for reading the output of external commands. When empty, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4902 encoding is not converted. |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4903 This is used for `:make`, `:lmake`, `:grep`, `:lgrep`, `:grepadd`, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4904 `:lgrepadd`, `:cfile`, `:cgetfile`, `:caddfile`, `:lfile`, `:lgetfile`, |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4905 and `:laddfile`. |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4906 |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4907 This would be mostly useful when you use MS-Windows and set 'encoding' |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4908 to "utf-8". If |+iconv| is enabled and GNU libiconv is used, setting |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4909 'makeencoding' to "char" has the same effect as setting to the system |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4910 locale encoding. Example: > |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4911 :set encoding=utf-8 |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4912 :set makeencoding=char " system locale is used |
e71d3bdf3bc3
patch 8.0.0420: text garbled when the system encoding differs from 'encoding'
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11062
diff
changeset
|
4913 < |
7 | 4914 *'makeprg'* *'mp'* |
4915 'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS") | |
4916 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
1152 | 4917 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|. |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
4918 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|), |
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
4919 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S| |
5690 | 4920 to escape file names in case they contain special characters. |
1152 | 4921 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash| |
4922 about including spaces and backslashes. | |
4923 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for | |
4924 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called | |
4925 "myfilter" do it like this: > | |
7 | 4926 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter |
4927 < The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify | |
4928 where the arguments will be included, for example: > | |
4929 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*} | |
4930 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
4931 security reasons. | |
4932 | |
4933 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'* | |
4934 'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]") | |
4935 local to buffer | |
4936 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the | |
4073 | 4937 other. |
4938 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot | |
4939 jump between two double quotes. | |
4940 The characters must be separated by a colon. | |
1152 | 4941 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and |
4942 '>' (HTML): > | |
7 | 4943 :set mps+=<:> |
4944 | |
4945 < A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an | |
4946 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: > | |
4947 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:; | |
4948 | |
4949 < For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in | |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
4950 the $VIMRUNTIME/pack/dist/opt/matchit directory. |add-local-help| |
7 | 4951 |
4952 *'matchtime'* *'mat'* | |
4953 'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5) | |
4954 global | |
4955 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is | |
4956 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that | |
4957 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi. | |
4958 | |
714 | 4959 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'* |
4960 'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2) | |
4961 global | |
4962 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying. | |
4963 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8". | |
4964 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4. | |
4965 Maximum value is 6. | |
4966 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more | |
4967 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|. | |
4968 See |mbyte-combining|. | |
4969 | |
7 | 4970 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'* |
4971 'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100) | |
4972 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
4973 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
1152 | 4974 feature} |
7 | 4975 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally |
4976 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with | |
4977 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use | |
4978 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted. | |
10498
883396809b45
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/bc2eada5424bff06f7eb77c032ecc067da52b846
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10449
diff
changeset
|
4979 Increasing this limit above 200 also changes the maximum for Ex |
14006 | 4980 command recursion, see |E169|. |
7 | 4981 See also |:function|. |
4982 | |
4983 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223* | |
4984 'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000) | |
4985 global | |
4986 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a | |
4987 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like | |
4988 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg", | |
4989 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also | |
4990 |key-mapping|. | |
4991 | |
4992 *'maxmem'* *'mm'* | |
4993 'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system | |
4994 dependent) or half the amount of memory | |
4995 available) | |
4996 global | |
4997 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this | |
4998 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause | |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
4999 other memory to be freed. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5000 The maximum usable value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5001 limit. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5002 The value is ignored when 'swapfile' is off. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5003 Also see 'maxmemtot'. |
7 | 5004 |
189 | 5005 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'* |
5006 'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000) | |
5007 global | |
5008 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5009 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit. |
189 | 5010 *E363* |
1152 | 5011 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly |
5012 behaves like CTRL-C was typed. | |
189 | 5013 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very |
5014 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern | |
5015 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better. | |
14298
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
5016 Might also happen on redraw, when syntax rules try to match a complex |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
5017 text structure. |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
5018 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit, in |
4a588e3afd4a
Update runtime files, add Danish translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14249
diff
changeset
|
5019 which case you get an "Out of memory" error instead. |
189 | 5020 |
7 | 5021 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'* |
5022 'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system | |
5023 dependent) or half the amount of memory | |
5024 available) | |
5025 global | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5026 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together. |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5027 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5028 without a limit. |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5029 On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But hey, do you really |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5030 need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? Keep in mind that text is |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
5031 stored in the swap file, one can edit files > 2 Gbyte anyway. We do |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
5032 need the memory to store undo info. |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5033 Buffers with 'swapfile' off still count to the total amount of memory |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5034 used. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
5035 Also see 'maxmem'. |
7 | 5036 |
5037 *'menuitems'* *'mis'* | |
5038 'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25) | |
5039 global | |
5040 {not available when compiled without the |+menu| | |
5041 feature} | |
5042 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are | |
5043 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this | |
5044 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first. | |
5045 | |
484 | 5046 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'* |
5047 'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500") | |
5048 global | |
5049 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
5050 feature} | |
5051 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the | |
5052 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but | |
5053 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used | |
5054 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why | |
5055 this tuning is complicated. | |
5056 | |
5057 There are three numbers, separated by commas: | |
5058 {start},{inc},{added} | |
5059 | |
5060 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start} | |
5061 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any | |
5062 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of | |
5063 memory that is available to Vim. | |
5064 | |
5065 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the | |
5066 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another | |
5067 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after | |
5068 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory | |
5069 will be allocated. | |
5070 | |
5071 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before | |
5072 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra | |
5073 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller | |
5074 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's | |
5075 slower. | |
5076 | |
5077 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and | |
5078 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If | |
5079 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: > | |
5080 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800 | |
5081 < If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some | |
5082 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to. | |
5083 | |
16798
63ac51f16ea1
patch 8.1.1401: misspelled mkspellmem as makespellmem
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16778
diff
changeset
|
5084 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|. |
63ac51f16ea1
patch 8.1.1401: misspelled mkspellmem as makespellmem
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16778
diff
changeset
|
5085 |
7 | 5086 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'* |
1111 | 5087 'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root), |
5088 Vi default: off) | |
7 | 5089 local to buffer |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5090 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5091 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5092 no lines are checked. See |modeline|. |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5093 |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5094 *'modelineexpr'* *'mle'* *'nomodelineexpr'* *'nomle'* |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5095 'modelineexpr' 'mle' boolean (default: off) |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5096 global |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5097 When on allow some options that are an expression to be set in the |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5098 modeline. Check the option for whether it is affected by |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5099 'modelineexpr'. Also see |modeline|. |
16740
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
5100 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
5101 security reasons. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5102 |
7 | 5103 *'modelines'* *'mls'* |
5104 'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5) | |
5105 global | |
5106 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is | |
5107 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero | |
5108 no lines are checked. See |modeline|. | |
5109 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
5110 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
5111 | |
5112 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'* | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
5113 *E21* |
7 | 5114 'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on) |
5115 local to buffer | |
5116 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and | |
5117 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed. | |
10617 | 5118 Can be reset on startup with the |-M| command line argument. |
7 | 5119 |
5120 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'* | |
5121 'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off) | |
5122 local to buffer | |
5123 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set | |
5124 when: | |
5125 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the | |
5126 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the | |
5127 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the | |
5128 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from | |
5129 when it was written. | |
5130 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original | |
5131 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or | |
5132 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original | |
5133 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be | |
5134 reset. | |
8748
b1a19a2f73f0
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4f3f668c8486444e53163c29d2fc79bf47eb3c82
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8629
diff
changeset
|
5135 Similarly for 'eol' and 'bomb'. |
3082 | 5136 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the |
5137 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost, | |
5138 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for | |
5139 an explanation. | |
7 | 5140 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but |
5141 will be ignored. | |
13437 | 5142 Note that the text may actually be the same, e.g. 'modified' is set |
5143 when using "rA" on an "A". | |
7 | 5144 |
5145 *'more'* *'nomore'* | |
5146 'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
5147 global | |
5148 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get | |
5149 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the | |
5150 listing continues until finished. | |
5151 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
5152 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
5153 | |
5154 *'mouse'* *E538* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5155 'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32, |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5156 set to "a" in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 5157 global |
5158 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals | |
1621 | 5159 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with |
5160 sysmouse and Linux console with gpm). For using the mouse in the | |
5161 GUI, see |gui-mouse|. | |
7 | 5162 The mouse can be enabled for different modes: |
12826 | 5163 n Normal mode and Terminal modes |
7 | 5164 v Visual mode |
5165 i Insert mode | |
5166 c Command-line mode | |
5167 h all previous modes when editing a help file | |
5168 a all previous modes | |
5169 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt | |
14864 | 5170 Normally you would enable the mouse in all five modes with: > |
7 | 5171 :set mouse=a |
5172 < When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for | |
5173 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor. | |
5174 | |
5175 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|. | |
5176 | |
5177 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the | |
10 | 5178 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of |
7 | 5179 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed. |
5180 Also see the 'clipboard' option. | |
5181 | |
5182 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'* | |
5183 'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off) | |
5184 global | |
5185 {only works in the GUI} | |
5186 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated. | |
5187 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the | |
5188 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the | |
5189 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as | |
5190 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally. | |
5191 | |
5192 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'* | |
5193 'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on) | |
5194 global | |
5195 {only works in the GUI} | |
5196 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed. | |
5197 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved. | |
5198 | |
5199 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'* | |
5200 'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32) | |
5201 global | |
5202 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what | |
5203 the right mouse button is used for: | |
5204 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works | |
5205 like in an xterm. | |
5206 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left | |
5207 mouse button extends a selection. This works like | |
233 | 5208 with Microsoft Windows. |
7 | 5209 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the |
5210 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the | |
5211 selected operation will act upon the clicked object. | |
5212 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will | |
233 | 5213 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of |
7 | 5214 course, that right clicking outside a selection will |
5215 end Visual mode. | |
5216 Overview of what button does what for each model: | |
5217 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~ | |
5218 left click place cursor place cursor | |
5219 left drag start selection start selection | |
5220 shift-left search word extend selection | |
5221 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor) | |
5222 right drag extend selection - | |
5223 middle click paste paste | |
5224 | |
5225 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu. | |
5226 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|. | |
13437 | 5227 In a terminal the popup menu works if Vim is compiled with the |
5228 |+insert_expand| option. | |
7 | 5229 |
5230 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings. | |
5231 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless | |
5232 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly). | |
5233 | |
5234 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
5235 | |
5236 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547* | |
15932 | 5237 'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i-r:beam,s:updown,sd:udsizing, |
5238 vs:leftright,vd:lrsizing,m:no, | |
5239 ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow") | |
7 | 5240 global |
5241 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape| | |
5242 feature} | |
5243 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in | |
5244 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much | |
5245 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list | |
5246 and an argument-list: | |
5247 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,.. | |
5248 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations: | |
5249 In a normal window: ~ | |
5250 n Normal mode | |
5251 v Visual mode | |
5252 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v', | |
5253 if not specified) | |
5254 o Operator-pending mode | |
5255 i Insert mode | |
5256 r Replace mode | |
5257 | |
5258 Others: ~ | |
5259 c appending to the command-line | |
5260 ci inserting in the command-line | |
5261 cr replacing in the command-line | |
5262 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts | |
5263 ml idem, but cursor in the last line | |
5264 e any mode, pointer below last window | |
5265 s any mode, pointer on a status line | |
5266 sd any mode, while dragging a status line | |
5267 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line | |
5268 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line | |
5269 a everywhere | |
5270 | |
5271 The shape is one of the following: | |
5272 avail name looks like ~ | |
5273 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer | |
5274 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!) | |
5275 w x beam I-beam | |
5276 w x updown up-down sizing arrows | |
5277 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows | |
5278 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer | |
5279 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer | |
5280 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing | |
5281 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing | |
5282 x crosshair like a big thin + | |
5283 x hand1 black hand | |
5284 x hand2 white hand | |
5285 x pencil what you write with | |
5286 x question big ? | |
5287 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up | |
5288 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up | |
5289 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h) | |
5290 | |
5291 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32, | |
5292 x for X11. | |
5293 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse | |
5294 pointer. | |
5295 | |
5296 Example: > | |
5297 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no | |
5298 < will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and | |
5299 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since | |
5300 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.) | |
5301 | |
5302 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'* | |
5303 'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500) | |
5304 global | |
5305 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum | |
5306 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be | |
5307 recognized as a multi click. | |
5308 | |
12608
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5309 *'mzschemedll'* |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5310 'mzschemedll' string (default depends on the build) |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5311 global |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5312 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn| |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5313 feature} |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5314 Specifies the name of the MzScheme shared library. The default is |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5315 DYNAMIC_MZSCH_DLL which was specified at compile time. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5316 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
12785 | 5317 The value must be set in the |vimrc| script or earlier. In the |
12756
3b26420fc639
Long overdue runtime update.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12744
diff
changeset
|
5318 startup, before the |load-plugins| step. |
12608
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5319 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5320 security reasons. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5321 |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5322 *'mzschemegcdll'* |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5323 'mzschemegcdll' string (default depends on the build) |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5324 global |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5325 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn| |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5326 feature} |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5327 Specifies the name of the MzScheme GC shared library. The default is |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5328 DYNAMIC_MZGC_DLL which was specified at compile time. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5329 The value can be equal to 'mzschemedll' if it includes the GC code. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5330 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5331 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5332 security reasons. |
b390f5003e2f
patch 8.0.1182: cannot see or change mzscheme dll name
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12559
diff
changeset
|
5333 |
14 | 5334 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'* |
5335 'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100) | |
5336 global | |
5337 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme| | |
5338 feature} | |
5339 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads. | |
5340 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling. | |
11160 | 5341 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
5342 is reset. | |
14 | 5343 |
7 | 5344 *'nrformats'* *'nf'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5345 'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "bin,octal,hex", |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
5346 set to "bin,hex" in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 5347 local to buffer |
5348 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the | |
5349 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number | |
5350 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands. | |
625 | 5351 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be |
7 | 5352 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5353 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats* |
625 | 5354 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered |
7 | 5355 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010". |
625 | 5356 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be |
7 | 5357 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on |
5358 "0x100" results in "0x0ff". | |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5359 bin If included, numbers starting with "0b" or "0B" will be |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5360 considered to be binary. Example: Using CTRL-X on |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5361 "0b1000" subtracts one, resulting in "0b0111". |
7 | 5362 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always |
5363 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not | |
5364 recognized as octal or hex. | |
5365 | |
5366 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'* | |
5367 'number' 'nu' boolean (default off) | |
5368 local to window | |
5369 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is | |
5370 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of | |
5371 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set). | |
13 | 5372 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line |
5373 number. | |
7 | 5374 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-' |
5375 characters are put before the number. | |
3445 | 5376 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for |
5377 the number. | |
4780 | 5378 *number_relativenumber* |
5379 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be | |
5380 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these | |
5381 four combinations (cursor in line 3): | |
5382 | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5383 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu' |
4780 | 5384 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu' |
5385 | |
5386 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple | |
5387 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear | |
5388 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody | |
5389 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there | |
7 | 5390 |
13 | 5391 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'* |
5392 'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8) | |
5393 local to window | |
14 | 5394 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak| |
5395 feature} | |
13 | 5396 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5397 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5398 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5399 the text, there is one less character for the number itself. |
13 | 5400 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5401 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5402 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber' |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5403 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5404 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used. |
17229
f1c7b7a4d9e4
patch 8.1.1614: 'numberwidth' can only go up to 10
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17161
diff
changeset
|
5405 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 20. |
11160 | 5406 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
5407 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
13 | 5408 |
523 | 5409 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'* |
5410 'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty) | |
502 | 5411 local to buffer |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5412 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5413 or |+insert_expand| features} |
623 | 5414 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni |
5415 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O| | |
648 | 5416 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is |
5417 invoked and what it should return. | |
1004 | 5418 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin: |
859 | 5419 |:filetype-plugin-on| |
3682 | 5420 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
5421 security reasons. | |
502 | 5422 |
5423 | |
1152 | 5424 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'* |
1004 | 5425 'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off) |
5426 global | |
5427 {only for MS-DOS, MS-Windows and OS/2} | |
5428 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a | |
5429 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore | |
5430 it is off by default. | |
5431 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also | |
5432 result in editing a device. | |
5433 | |
5434 | |
593 | 5435 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'* |
5436 'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty) | |
5437 global | |
5438 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator. | |
5439 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example. | |
5440 | |
5441 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5442 security reasons. | |
5443 | |
5444 | |
2908 | 5445 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'* |
5446 'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "") | |
7 | 5447 local to buffer |
2908 | 5448 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed. |
5449 | |
7 | 5450 |
8182
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5451 *'packpath'* *'pp'* |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5452 'packpath' 'pp' string (default: see 'runtimepath') |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5453 Directories used to find packages. See |packages|. |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5454 |
95d59081580f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/f6fee0e2d4341c0c2f5339c1268e5877fafd07cf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8148
diff
changeset
|
5455 |
7 | 5456 *'paragraphs'* *'para'* |
1564 | 5457 'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp") |
7 | 5458 global |
5459 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs | |
5460 of two letters (see |object-motions|). | |
5461 | |
5462 *'paste'* *'nopaste'* | |
5463 'paste' boolean (default off) | |
5464 global | |
10 | 5465 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy |
5466 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid | |
7 | 5467 unexpected effects. |
5468 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim | |
10 | 5469 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim |
7 | 5470 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste' |
5471 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the | |
5472 mouse clicks itself. | |
148 | 5473 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in |
5474 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting | |
5475 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button | |
5476 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping. | |
7 | 5477 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on): |
5478 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled | |
5479 - abbreviations are disabled | |
5480 - 'autoindent' is reset | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5481 - 'expandtab' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5482 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty |
7 | 5483 - 'revins' is reset |
5484 - 'ruler' is reset | |
5485 - 'showmatch' is reset | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5486 - 'smartindent' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5487 - 'smarttab' is reset |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5488 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0 |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5489 - 'textwidth' is set to 0 |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5490 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0 |
7 | 5491 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled: |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5492 - 'cindent' |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
5493 - 'indentexpr' |
7 | 5494 - 'lisp' |
5495 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is | |
5496 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the | |
5497 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to | |
5498 set the 'paste' option again. | |
5499 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to | |
5500 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on. | |
5501 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect. | |
5502 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use | |
5503 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key. | |
5504 | |
5505 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'* | |
5506 'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "") | |
5507 global | |
5508 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste' | |
5509 option. This is like specifying a mapping: > | |
5510 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR> | |
5511 < Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'. | |
5512 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set. | |
5513 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in | |
5514 Command-line mode. | |
5515 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However, | |
5516 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do | |
5517 this: > | |
5518 :map <F10> :set paste<CR> | |
5519 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR> | |
5520 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR> | |
5521 :imap <F11> <nop> | |
5522 :set pastetoggle=<F11> | |
5523 < This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode. | |
5524 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste | |
5525 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key | |
5526 sequence. | |
1621 | 5527 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies. |
7 | 5528 |
5529 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'* | |
5530 'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "") | |
5531 global | |
5532 {not available when compiled without the |+diff| | |
5533 feature} | |
5534 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate | |
10 | 5535 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|. |
7 | 5536 |
6091
7090d7f160f7
Update runtime files. Add vroom file support.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
6032
diff
changeset
|
5537 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206* |
7 | 5538 'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "") |
5539 global | |
5540 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used | |
5541 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a | |
5542 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a | |
5543 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the | |
5544 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option | |
5545 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like | |
13100
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5546 ".orig" or ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5547 (Detail: The backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5548 new file has been successfully written, that's why it must be possible |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5549 to write a backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an |
656ab57d1ddc
update a few runtime files
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13051
diff
changeset
|
5550 empty file is created. |
7 | 5551 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made. |
5552 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the | |
5553 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always | |
5554 recognized as a compressed file. | |
36 | 5555 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 5556 |
3224 | 5557 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854* |
7 | 5558 'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,," |
5559 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,," | |
5560 other systems: ".,,") | |
5561 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
5562 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the | |
1668 | 5563 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands, |
5564 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not | |
5565 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path' | |
5566 option may be relative or absolute. | |
7 | 5567 - Use commas to separate directory names: > |
5568 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include | |
5569 < - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards | |
5570 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory | |
5571 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: > | |
5572 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space | |
5573 < - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra | |
5574 backslash: > | |
5575 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma | |
5576 < - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: > | |
5577 :set path=. | |
5578 < - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two | |
5579 commas: > | |
5580 :set path=,, | |
5581 < - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'. | |
5582 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
5583 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding | |
5584 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work. | |
1668 | 5585 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and |
5586 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax. | |
7 | 5587 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature} |
5588 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: > | |
5589 :set path=.,c:\\include | |
5590 < Or just use '/' instead: > | |
5591 :set path=.,c:/include | |
5592 < Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as | |
5593 the file! | |
10 | 5594 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly |
7 | 5595 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters. |
5596 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of | |
5597 'path', see |:checkpath|. | |
5598 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
5599 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
5600 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: > | |
5601 :set path-= | |
5602 < To add the current directory use: > | |
5603 :set path+= | |
5604 < To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the | |
5605 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory | |
5606 names are separated with a semi-colon: > | |
5607 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g') | |
5608 < Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that | |
5609 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space. | |
5610 | |
12499 | 5611 *'perldll'* |
5612 'perldll' string (default depends on the build) | |
5613 global | |
5614 {only available when compiled with the |+perl/dyn| | |
5615 feature} | |
5616 Specifies the name of the Perl shared library. The default is | |
5617 DYNAMIC_PERL_DLL, which was specified at compile time. | |
5618 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
5619 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
5620 security reasons. | |
5621 | |
7 | 5622 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'* |
5623 'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off) | |
5624 local to buffer | |
5625 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the | |
5626 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a | |
5627 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is | |
5628 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option | |
5629 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible | |
5630 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required. | |
1621 | 5631 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains |
5632 a Tab. | |
7 | 5633 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of |
5634 tabs and spaces. You might not like this. | |
11160 | 5635 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 5636 Also see 'copyindent'. |
5637 Use |:retab| to clean up white space. | |
5638 | |
5639 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'* | |
5640 'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12) | |
5641 global | |
5642 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5643 |+quickfix| features} |
7 | 5644 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated |
17431
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5645 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given. Not used when |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5646 'previewpopup' is set. |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5647 |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5648 *'previewpopup'* *'pvp'* |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5649 'previewpopup' 'pvp' string (default empty) |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5650 global |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5651 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|, |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5652 |+textprop| or |+quickfix| feature} |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5653 When not empty a popup window is used for commands that would open a |
ce35cdbe9f74
patch 8.1.1714: cannot preview a file in a popup window
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17372
diff
changeset
|
5654 preview window. See |preview-popup|. |
7 | 5655 |
5656 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'* | |
5657 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590* | |
5658 'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off) | |
5659 local to window | |
5660 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
5661 |+quickfix| features} |
10 | 5662 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option |
7 | 5663 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands |
5664 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc. | |
5665 | |
5666 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'* | |
5667 'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty) | |
5668 global | |
5669 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5670 feature} | |
15 | 5671 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|. |
5672 See |pdev-option|. | |
36 | 5673 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
5674 security reasons. | |
15 | 5675 |
5676 *'printencoding'* *'penc'* | |
14864 | 5677 'printencoding' 'penc' string (default empty, except for some systems) |
7 | 5678 global |
5679 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5680 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5681 Sets the character encoding used when printing. |
5682 See |penc-option|. | |
7 | 5683 |
5684 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'* | |
14864 | 5685 'printexpr' 'pexpr' string (default: see below) |
7 | 5686 global |
5687 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5688 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5689 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|. |
5690 See |pexpr-option|. | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
5691 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
5692 security reasons. |
15 | 5693 |
5694 *'printfont'* *'pfn'* | |
7 | 5695 'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier") |
5696 global | |
5697 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5698 feature} | |
15 | 5699 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|. |
5700 See |pfn-option|. | |
7 | 5701 |
5702 *'printheader'* *'pheader'* | |
5703 'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N") | |
5704 global | |
5705 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| | |
5706 feature} | |
15 | 5707 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output. |
5708 See |pheader-option|. | |
5709 | |
5710 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'* | |
5711 'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "") | |
5712 global | |
15878 | 5713 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| |
5714 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5715 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|. |
5716 See |pmbcs-option|. | |
5717 | |
5718 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'* | |
5719 'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "") | |
5720 global | |
15878 | 5721 {only available when compiled with the |+printer| |
5722 and |+postscript| features} | |
15 | 5723 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|. |
5724 See |pmbfn-option|. | |
7 | 5725 |
5726 *'printoptions'* *'popt'* | |
5727 'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "") | |
5728 global | |
5729 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature} | |
15 | 5730 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|. |
5731 See |popt-option|. | |
5732 | |
168 | 5733 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'* |
5734 'prompt' boolean (default on) | |
5735 global | |
5736 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode. | |
5737 | |
766 | 5738 *'pumheight'* *'ph'* |
5739 'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0) | |
5740 global | |
5741 {not available when compiled without the | |
5742 |+insert_expand| feature} | |
853 | 5743 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for |
5744 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used. | |
766 | 5745 |ins-completion-menu|. |
5746 | |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5747 *'pumwidth'* *'pw'* |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5748 'pumwidth' 'pw' number (default 15) |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5749 global |
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5750 {not available when compiled without the |
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5751 |+insert_expand| feature} |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
5752 Determines the minimum width to use for the popup menu for Insert mode |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
5753 completion. |ins-completion-menu|. |
13234
6e972d830e13
patch 8.0.1491: the minimum width of the popup menu is hard coded
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13231
diff
changeset
|
5754 |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5755 *'pythondll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
5756 'pythondll' string (default depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5757 global |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5758 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn| |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5759 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5760 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5761 DYNAMIC_PYTHON_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
5762 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7228
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5763 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5764 security reasons. |
873eae260c97
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/b4ff518d95aa57c2f8c0568c915035bef849581b
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7218
diff
changeset
|
5765 |
13154
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5766 *'pythonhome'* |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5767 'pythonhome' string (default "") |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5768 global |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5769 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn| |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5770 feature} |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5771 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x home directory. When 'pythonhome' |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5772 and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, PYTHON_HOME, |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5773 which was specified at compile time, will be used for the Python 2.x |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5774 home directory. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5775 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5776 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5777 security reasons. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5778 |
7218
36dc8df8560f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0796c0625fa4b9eb2f47fe8c976b78523924e1fb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7196
diff
changeset
|
5779 *'pythonthreedll'* |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5780 'pythonthreedll' string (default depends on the build) |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5781 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5782 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5783 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5784 Specifies the name of the Python 3 shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
5785 DYNAMIC_PYTHON3_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
5786 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5787 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5788 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
5789 |
13154
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5790 *'pythonthreehome'* |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5791 'pythonthreehome' string (default "") |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5792 global |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5793 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn| |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5794 feature} |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5795 Specifies the name of the Python 3 home directory. When |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5796 'pythonthreehome' and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5797 PYTHON3_HOME, which was specified at compile time, will be used for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5798 the Python 3 home directory. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5799 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5800 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5801 security reasons. |
53cc7ea77c54
patch 8.0.1451: difficult to set the python home directories properly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13150
diff
changeset
|
5802 |
10722
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5803 *'pyxversion'* *'pyx'* |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5804 'pyxversion' 'pyx' number (default depends on the build) |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5805 global |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5806 {only available when compiled with the |+python| or |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5807 the |+python3| feature} |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5808 Specifies the python version used for pyx* functions and commands |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5809 |python_x|. The default value is as follows: |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5810 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5811 Compiled with Default ~ |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5812 |+python| and |+python3| 0 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5813 only |+python| 2 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5814 only |+python3| 3 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5815 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5816 Available values are 0, 2 and 3. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5817 If 'pyxversion' is 0, it is set to 2 or 3 after the first execution of |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5818 any python2/3 commands or functions. E.g. `:py` sets to 2, and `:py3` |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5819 sets to 3. `:pyx` sets it to 3 if Python 3 is available, otherwise sets |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5820 to 2 if Python 2 is available. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5821 See also: |has-pythonx| |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5822 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5823 If Vim is compiled with only |+python| or |+python3| setting |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5824 'pyxversion' has no effect. The pyx* functions and commands are |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5825 always the same as the compiled version. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5826 |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5827 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5828 security reasons. |
7598ce51bf2a
patch 8.0.0251: not easy to select Python 2 or 3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10617
diff
changeset
|
5829 |
140 | 5830 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'* |
12 | 5831 'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\") |
5832 local to buffer | |
5833 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for | |
5834 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|. | |
5835 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string, | |
5836 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the | |
5837 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string. | |
5838 | |
7 | 5839 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'* |
5840 'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off) | |
5841 local to buffer | |
5842 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from | |
5843 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started | |
5844 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view". | |
164 | 5845 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current |
5846 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'. | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
5847 When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is set for the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
5848 newly edited buffer. |
10617 | 5849 See 'modifiable' for disallowing changes to the buffer. |
7 | 5850 |
1521 | 5851 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'* |
5852 'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000) | |
5853 global | |
5854 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime| | |
5855 feature} | |
5856 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to | |
13818
28ac7914b2b6
Update runtime files and translations
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13742
diff
changeset
|
5857 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch', |:match| highlighting and syntax |
11529
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5858 highlighting. |
1521 | 5859 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further |
11529
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5860 matches will be highlighted. |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5861 For syntax highlighting the time applies per window. When over the |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5862 limit syntax highlighting is disabled until |CTRL-L| is used. |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5863 This is used to avoid that Vim hangs when using a very complicated |
998d2cf59caa
patch 8.0.0647: syntax highlighting can make cause a freeze
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11516
diff
changeset
|
5864 pattern. |
1521 | 5865 |
4681
2eb30f341e8d
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
5866 *'regexpengine'* *'re'* |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5867 'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0) |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5868 global |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5869 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines| |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5870 The possible values are: |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5871 0 automatic selection |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5872 1 old engine |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5873 2 NFA engine |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5874 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5875 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful |
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5876 for debugging the regexp engine. |
6328 | 5877 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the |
5878 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too | |
5879 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of | |
5880 a complex pattern with long text. | |
4502
605c9ce57ec3
Updated runtime files, language files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4358
diff
changeset
|
5881 |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5882 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'* |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5883 'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off) |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5884 local to window |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5885 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of |
2207
b17bbfa96fa0
Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2204
diff
changeset
|
5886 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5887 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5888 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5889 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =). |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5890 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5891 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5892 'compatible' isn't set). |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5893 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5894 number. |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5895 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-' |
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5896 characters are put before the number. |
3445 | 5897 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for |
5898 the number. | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
5899 |
4780 | 5900 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of |
5901 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two | |
5902 options. | |
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32
Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2154
diff
changeset
|
5903 |
7 | 5904 *'remap'* *'noremap'* |
5905 'remap' boolean (default on) | |
5906 global | |
5907 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for | |
5908 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command. | |
717 | 5909 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep |
5910 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with | |
5911 old Vi scripts. | |
7 | 5912 |
6110 | 5913 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'* |
5914 'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty) | |
5915 global | |
5916 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on | |
5917 MS-Windows} | |
5918 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the | |
5919 renderer. | |
5920 | |
5921 Syntax: > | |
5922 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})* | |
5923 < | |
5924 Currently, only one optional renderer is available. | |
5925 | |
5926 render behavior ~ | |
5927 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes | |
5928 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI. | |
5929 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on | |
5930 MS-Windows Vista or newer version. | |
5931 | |
5932 Options: | |
5933 name meaning type value ~ | |
5934 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe) | |
5935 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown) | |
5936 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown) | |
5937 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below) | |
5938 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below) | |
5939 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below) | |
13150
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
5940 scrlines Scroll Lines int (deprecated) |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5941 |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5942 See this URL for detail (except for scrlines): |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5943 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx |
6110 | 5944 |
5945 For geom: structure of a device pixel. | |
5946 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT | |
5947 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB | |
5948 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR | |
5949 | |
5950 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5951 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx |
6110 | 5952 |
5953 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs. | |
5954 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT | |
5955 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED | |
5956 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC | |
5957 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL | |
5958 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL | |
5959 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC | |
5960 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE | |
5961 | |
5962 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5963 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx |
6110 | 5964 |
5965 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text. | |
5966 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT | |
5967 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE | |
5968 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE | |
5969 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED | |
5970 | |
5971 See this URL for detail: | |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5972 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx |
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5973 |
13150
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
5974 For scrlines: |
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
5975 This was used for optimizing scrolling behavior, however this |
808625d4b71b
patch 8.0.1449: slow redrawing with DirectX
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13100
diff
changeset
|
5976 is now deprecated. If specified, it is simply ignored. |
6110 | 5977 |
5978 Example: > | |
5979 set encoding=utf-8 | |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5980 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12 |
6110 | 5981 set rop=type:directx |
5982 < | |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5983 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys which |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5984 have ".fon" extension in file name) to 'guifont', it will be |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5985 drawn by GDI as a fallback. |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5986 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5987 NOTE: It is known that some fonts and options combination |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5988 causes trouble on drawing glyphs. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5989 |
12986
18e6f4addce9
patch 8.0.1369: MS-Windows: drawing underline slow, mFallbackDC not updated
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12971
diff
changeset
|
5990 - 'renmode:5' and 'renmode:6' will not work with some |
12934
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5991 special made fonts (True-Type fonts which includes only |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5992 bitmap glyphs). |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5993 - 'taamode:3' will not work with some vector fonts. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5994 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5995 NOTE: With this option, you can display colored emoji |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5996 (emoticon) in Windows 8.1 or later. To display colored emoji, |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5997 there are some conditions which you should notice. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5998 |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
5999 - If your font includes non-colored emoji already, it will |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6000 be used. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6001 - If your font doesn't have emoji, the system chooses an |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6002 alternative symbol font. On Windows 10, "Segoe UI Emoji" |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6003 will be used. |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6004 - When this alternative font didn't have fixed width glyph, |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6005 emoji might be rendered beyond the bounding box of drawing |
2ebc3df65ca2
patch 8.0.1343: MS-Windows: does not show colored emojis
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12930
diff
changeset
|
6006 cell. |
6110 | 6007 |
6008 Other render types are currently not supported. | |
6009 | |
7 | 6010 *'report'* |
6011 'report' number (default 2) | |
6012 global | |
6013 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of | |
6014 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most | |
6015 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0. | |
6016 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used | |
6017 instead of the number of lines. | |
6018 | |
6019 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'* | |
6020 'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on) | |
6021 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
6022 {only in Windows 95/NT console version} |
7 | 6023 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also |
6024 happens when executing external commands. | |
6025 | |
6026 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te' | |
6027 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring: | |
6028 set t_ti= t_te= | |
6029 To enable restoring (for an xterm): | |
6030 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8 | |
6031 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it) | |
6032 | |
6033 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'* | |
6034 'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off) | |
6035 global | |
6036 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
6037 feature} | |
6038 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing | |
6039 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_ | |
6040 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6041 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6042 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6043 reset. |
7 | 6044 |
6045 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'* | |
6046 'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off) | |
6047 local to window | |
6048 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
6049 feature} | |
6050 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters | |
6051 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left. | |
6052 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that | |
6053 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic. | |
6054 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files | |
6055 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is | |
6056 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left | |
6057 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly | |
6058 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|. | |
6059 | |
2341 | 6060 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'* |
7 | 6061 'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search") |
6062 local to window | |
6063 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft| | |
6064 feature} | |
6065 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in | |
6066 right-to-left mode for a group of commands: | |
6067 | |
6068 search "/" and "?" commands | |
6069 | |
6070 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi. | |
6071 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect. | |
6072 | |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6073 *'rubydll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
6074 'rubydll' string (default: depends on the build) |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6075 global |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6076 {only available when compiled with the |+ruby/dyn| |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6077 feature} |
7528
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6078 Specifies the name of the Ruby shared library. The default is |
53163e4d9e4f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/25e4fcde767084d1a79e0926bc301c92987c0cce
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7477
diff
changeset
|
6079 DYNAMIC_RUBY_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
6080 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7196
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6081 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6082 security reasons. |
42717d048817
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d94464ee294a351ce7b6ba18e8bd3f24f1bef920
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7147
diff
changeset
|
6083 |
7 | 6084 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6085 'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 6086 global |
6087 {not available when compiled without the | |
6088 |+cmdline_info| feature} | |
6089 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a | |
10 | 6090 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed |
7 | 6091 text in the file is shown on the far right: |
6092 Top first line is visible | |
6093 Bot last line is visible | |
6094 All first and last line are visible | |
6095 45% relative position in the file | |
6096 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler. | |
10 | 6097 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the |
7 | 6098 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the |
233 | 6099 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty), |
7 | 6100 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat' |
6101 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of | |
6102 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both | |
6103 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown, | |
6104 separated with a dash. | |
6105 For an empty line "0-1" is shown. | |
6106 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1". | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6107 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6108 reset. |
7 | 6109 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where |
6110 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|. | |
6111 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6112 | |
6113 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'* | |
6114 'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty) | |
6115 global | |
6116 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| | |
6117 feature} | |
6118 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler | |
6119 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option. | |
692 | 6120 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
6121 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
6122 |
7 | 6123 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15 |
6124 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end. | |
6125 Example: > | |
6126 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%) | |
6127 < | |
6128 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles* | |
6129 'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default: | |
6130 Unix: "$HOME/.vim, | |
6131 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6132 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6133 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6134 $HOME/.vim/after" | |
6135 Amiga: "home:vimfiles, | |
6136 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6137 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6138 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6139 home:vimfiles/after" | |
6140 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles, | |
6141 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6142 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6143 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
6144 $HOME/vimfiles/after" | |
6145 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles, | |
6146 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6147 $VIM:vimfiles:after" | |
6148 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles, | |
6149 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6150 Choices:vimfiles/after" | |
6151 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles, | |
6152 $VIM/vimfiles, | |
6153 $VIMRUNTIME, | |
6154 $VIM/vimfiles/after, | |
233 | 6155 sys$login:vimfiles/after") |
7 | 6156 global |
6157 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime | |
6158 files: | |
6159 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype| | |
6160 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts| | |
164 | 6161 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions| |
7 | 6162 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme| |
6163 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler| | |
6164 doc/ documentation |write-local-help| | |
6165 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin| | |
6166 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression| | |
6167 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap| | |
6168 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans| | |
6169 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim| | |
9116
bc38030aec7d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/26852128a2b713ef49341a0c18daba928444e7eb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9098
diff
changeset
|
6170 pack/ packages |:packadd| |
7 | 6171 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin| |
6172 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding| | |
650 | 6173 spell/ spell checking files |spell| |
7 | 6174 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile| |
6175 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor| | |
6176 | |
6177 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command. | |
6178 | |
6179 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations: | |
6180 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences. | |
6181 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system | |
6182 administrator. | |
6183 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim. | |
6184 *after-directory* | |
6185 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is | |
6186 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed | |
6187 defaults (rarely needed) | |
6188 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for | |
6189 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults | |
6190 or system-wide settings (rarely needed). | |
6191 | |
10211
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6192 More entries are added when using |packages|. If it gets very long |
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6193 then `:set rtp` will be truncated, use `:echo &rtp` to see the full |
b7da8d4c594c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d07969093a9b3051511c478d71c36de6fc33c0d6
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10198
diff
changeset
|
6194 string. |
9116
bc38030aec7d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/26852128a2b713ef49341a0c18daba928444e7eb
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9098
diff
changeset
|
6195 |
7 | 6196 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal |
6197 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for | |
10 | 6198 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid |
7 | 6199 wildcards. |
6200 See |:runtime|. | |
6201 Example: > | |
6202 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME | |
6203 < This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your | |
6204 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a | |
6205 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime | |
6206 files). | |
6207 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the | |
6208 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME | |
6209 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put | |
6210 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed | |
6211 runtime files. | |
13437 | 6212 When Vim is started with |--clean| the home directory entries are not |
6213 included. | |
7 | 6214 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6215 security reasons. | |
6216 | |
6217 *'scroll'* *'scr'* | |
6218 'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height) | |
6219 local to window | |
6220 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be | |
6221 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size | |
6222 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will | |
10 | 6223 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window |
16553
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
6224 height with ":set scroll=0". |
7 | 6225 |
6226 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'* | |
6227 'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off) | |
6228 local to window | |
6229 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current | |
6230 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have | |
6231 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the | |
6232 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'. | |
6233 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be | |
6234 interpreted. | |
6235 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another | |
6236 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows | |
6237 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not. | |
6238 | |
6239 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'* | |
6240 'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1) | |
6241 global | |
6242 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the | |
6243 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E, | |
6244 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly. | |
532 | 6245 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the |
6246 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window | |
6247 height. | |
7 | 6248 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set. |
6249 | |
6250 *'scrolloff'* *'so'* | |
10218
584c835a2de1
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/50ba526fbf3e9e5e0e6b0b3086a4d5df581ebc7e
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10211
diff
changeset
|
6251 'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0, set to 5 in |defaults.vim|) |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6252 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 6253 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor. |
6254 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If | |
6255 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be | |
6256 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or | |
6257 when long lines wrap). | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6258 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6259 these two: > |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6260 setlocal scrolloff< |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6261 setlocal scrolloff=-1 |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6262 < For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'. |
7 | 6263 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
6264 | |
6265 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'* | |
6266 'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump") | |
6267 global | |
6268 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how | |
236 | 6269 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind |
6270 Options. | |
7 | 6271 The following words are available: |
6272 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows | |
6273 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows | |
6274 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical | |
6275 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first | |
6276 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving | |
6277 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may | |
6278 reach a position before the start or after the end of | |
6279 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when | |
6280 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll | |
6281 to the desired position when possible. | |
6282 When now making that window the current one, two | |
6283 things can be done with the relative offset: | |
6284 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is | |
6285 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current | |
6286 window. When going back to the other window, the | |
1152 | 6287 new relative offset will be used. |
7 | 6288 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are |
6289 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When | |
6290 going back to the other window, it still uses the | |
6291 same relative offset. | |
6292 Also see |scroll-binding|. | |
819 | 6293 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding, |
6294 even when "ver" isn't there. | |
7 | 6295 |
6296 *'sections'* *'sect'* | |
6297 'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh") | |
6298 global | |
6299 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of | |
6300 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start | |
6301 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh". | |
6302 | |
6303 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523* | |
6304 'secure' boolean (default off) | |
6305 global | |
6306 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in | |
6307 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are | |
6308 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into | |
6309 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is | |
6310 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be | |
10 | 6311 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set |
7 | 6312 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then. |
6313 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6314 security reasons. | |
6315 | |
6316 *'selection'* *'sel'* | |
6317 'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive") | |
6318 global | |
6319 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used | |
6320 in Visual and Select mode. | |
6321 Possible values: | |
6322 value past line inclusive ~ | |
6323 old no yes | |
6324 inclusive yes yes | |
6325 exclusive yes no | |
6326 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one | |
6327 character past the line. | |
6328 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included | |
6329 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the | |
6330 selection. | |
9975
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
6331 When "old" is used and 'virtualedit' allows the cursor to move past |
03fa8a51e9dc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/e4a3bcf28d92d0bde9ca227ccb40d401038185e5
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9913
diff
changeset
|
6332 the end of line the line break still isn't included. |
7 | 6333 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end |
6334 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when | |
6335 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty. | |
6336 | |
6337 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
6338 | |
6339 *'selectmode'* *'slm'* | |
6340 'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "") | |
6341 global | |
6342 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start | |
6343 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started. | |
6344 Possible values: | |
6345 mouse when using the mouse | |
6346 key when using shifted special keys | |
6347 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V | |
6348 See |Select-mode|. | |
6349 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command. | |
6350 | |
6351 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'* | |
6352 'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds, | |
13437 | 6353 help,options,tabpages,winsize,terminal") |
7 | 6354 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6355 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 6356 feature} |
6357 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma | |
6358 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring | |
6359 something: | |
6360 word save and restore ~ | |
6361 blank empty windows | |
6362 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows | |
6363 curdir the current directory | |
6364 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local | |
6365 fold options | |
6366 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter | |
75 | 6367 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only |
6368 String and Number types are stored. | |
7 | 6369 help the help window |
6370 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not | |
6371 global values for local options) | |
6372 options all options and mappings (also global values for local | |
6373 options) | |
6374 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns' | |
6375 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located | |
6376 will become the current directory (useful with | |
6377 projects accessed over a network from different | |
6378 systems) | |
6379 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward | |
6380 slashes | |
827 | 6381 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page |
6382 is restored, so that you can make a session for each | |
6383 tab page separately | |
14519 | 6384 terminal include terminal windows where the command can be |
6385 restored | |
7 | 6386 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when |
6387 on Windows or DOS | |
6388 winpos position of the whole Vim window | |
6389 winsize window sizes | |
6390 | |
6391 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir". | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6392 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6393 with absolute paths. |
7 | 6394 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files |
6395 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts, | |
6396 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts. | |
6397 | |
6398 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91* | |
6399 'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh", | |
6400 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or | |
6401 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd") | |
6402 global | |
6403 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the | |
6404 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash' | |
6405 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'. | |
10 | 6406 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f". |
7 | 6407 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. |
6408 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6409 |
7 | 6410 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6411 it in quotes or escape the space. Example with quotes: > |
7 | 6412 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f |
6413 < Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and | |
10 | 6414 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the |
7 | 6415 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6416 name. Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path |
7 | 6417 separators. |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6418 Example with escaped space (Vim will do this when initializing the |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6419 option from $SHELL): > |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6420 :set shell=/bin/with\\\ space/sh |
14519 | 6421 < The resulting value of 'shell' is "/bin/with\ space/sh", two |
13162
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6422 backslashes are consumed by `:set`. |
51521b8a370c
patch 8.0.1455: if $SHELL contains a space then 'shell' is incorrect
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13154
diff
changeset
|
6423 |
7 | 6424 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be |
6425 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com" | |
6426 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g., | |
6427 filtering). | |
6428 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is | |
6429 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: > | |
6430 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos | |
6431 < This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6432 security reasons. | |
6433 | |
6434 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'* | |
3356 | 6435 'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c"; |
3371 | 6436 MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' does not |
6437 contain "sh" somewhere: "/c") | |
7 | 6438 global |
6439 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g., | |
6440 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like | |
6441 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to | |
11262 | 6442 reduce the need to set this option by the user. |
3082 | 6443 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated |
6444 part is passed as an argument to the shell command. | |
6445 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes. | |
6446 Also see |dos-shell| for MS-DOS and MS-Windows. | |
7 | 6447 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6448 security reasons. | |
6449 | |
6450 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'* | |
6451 'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee") | |
6452 global | |
6453 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix| | |
6454 feature} | |
6455 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the | |
10 | 6456 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about |
7 | 6457 including spaces and backslashes. |
6458 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary | |
6459 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value | |
6460 of this option). | |
6461 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly | |
6462 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen. | |
6463 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved | |
6464 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or | |
6465 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the | |
2788 | 6466 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh" or "bash" the |
6467 default becomes "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included. | |
6468 Before using the 'shell' option a path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses | |
6469 "sh". | |
7 | 6470 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc" |
6471 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set | |
6472 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was | |
6473 explicitly set before. | |
6474 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the | |
6475 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg' | |
6476 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do | |
6477 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space. | |
6478 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ". | |
6479 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will | |
6480 become obsolete (at least for Unix). | |
6481 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6482 security reasons. | |
6483 | |
6484 *'shellquote'* *'shq'* | |
6485 'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' | |
6486 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"") | |
6487 global | |
6488 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for | |
6489 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the | |
6490 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's | |
6491 probably not useful to set both options. | |
6492 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for | |
6493 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell | |
6494 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according | |
6495 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the | |
6496 user. See |dos-shell|. | |
6497 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6498 security reasons. | |
6499 | |
6500 *'shellredir'* *'srr'* | |
6501 'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1") | |
6502 global | |
6503 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary | |
6504 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces | |
6505 and backslashes. | |
6506 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary | |
6507 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value | |
6508 of this option). | |
6509 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh" | |
6510 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the | |
6511 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes | |
6512 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included. | |
6513 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked | |
6514 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with | |
6515 ".exe" appended are checked for. | |
6516 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc" | |
6517 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set | |
6518 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was | |
6519 explicitly set before. | |
6520 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will | |
6521 become obsolete (at least for Unix). | |
6522 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
6523 security reasons. | |
6524 | |
6525 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'* | |
6526 'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off) | |
6527 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
6528 {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2} |
7 | 6529 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is |
6530 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or | |
6531 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to | |
6532 forward slashes by Vim. | |
6533 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some | |
6534 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening | |
6535 any file for best results. This might change in the future. | |
6536 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path | |
6537 separator. To test if this is so use: > | |
6538 if exists('+shellslash') | |
17543
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
6539 < Also see 'completeslash'. |
77c3f6428b6c
patch 8.1.1769: 'shellslash' is also used for completion
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17433
diff
changeset
|
6540 |
168 | 6541 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'* |
6542 'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on) | |
6543 global | |
6544 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe. | |
6545 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway. | |
2965 | 6546 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and |
6547 later. You can check it with: > | |
168 | 6548 :if has("filterpipe") |
6549 < The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file | |
6550 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection. | |
6551 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding | |
6552 can be detected. | |
6553 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|, | |
6554 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when | |
6555 'shelltemp' is off. | |
9533
9f921133ee90
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/269f595f9eef584937e7eae70fde68cdd7da5bcf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9464
diff
changeset
|
6556 The `system()` function does not respect this option and always uses |
9f921133ee90
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/269f595f9eef584937e7eae70fde68cdd7da5bcf
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9464
diff
changeset
|
6557 temp files. |
11160 | 6558 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
6559 is reset. | |
168 | 6560 |
7 | 6561 *'shelltype'* *'st'* |
6562 'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0) | |
6563 global | |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
6564 {only for the Amiga} |
7 | 6565 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work |
6566 which use a shell. | |
6567 0 and 1: always use the shell | |
6568 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines | |
6569 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command | |
6570 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly. | |
6571 | |
6572 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands | |
6573 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands | |
6574 | |
3371 | 6575 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'* |
6576 'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: ""; | |
6577 for MS-DOS and MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^") | |
6578 global | |
6579 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this | |
6580 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible | |
6581 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe. | |
6582 | |
7 | 6583 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'* |
6584 'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: ""; | |
3359 | 6585 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "(" |
6586 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh" | |
6587 somewhere: "\"" | |
7 | 6588 for Unix, when using system(): "\"") |
6589 global | |
6590 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for | |
6591 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See | |
6592 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful | |
6593 to set both options. | |
3359 | 6594 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"(' |
6595 then ')"' is appended. | |
6596 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'. | |
3352 | 6597 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be |
6598 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe which automatically | |
6599 strips off the first and last quote on a command, or 3rd-party shells | |
6600 such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The | |
6601 default is adjusted according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need | |
6602 to set this option by the user. See |dos-shell|. | |
7 | 6603 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6604 security reasons. | |
6605 | |
6606 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'* | |
6607 'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off) | |
6608 global | |
6609 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and < | |
6610 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to | |
6611 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible). | |
6612 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6613 | |
6614 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'* | |
6615 'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8) | |
6616 local to buffer | |
10 | 6617 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for |
7 | 6618 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc. |
3893 | 6619 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()| |
6620 function to get the effective shiftwidth value. | |
7 | 6621 |
6622 *'shortmess'* *'shm'* | |
16533
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
6623 'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToOS", Vi default: "S", |
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
6624 POSIX default: "AS") |
7 | 6625 global |
6626 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file | |
6627 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages. | |
6628 It is a list of flags: | |
6629 flag meaning when present ~ | |
6630 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)" | |
6631 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]" | |
6632 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters" | |
6633 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]" | |
6634 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]" | |
6635 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]" | |
6636 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message | |
6637 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command | |
6638 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of | |
6639 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]". | |
6640 a all of the above abbreviations | |
6641 | |
6642 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message | |
6643 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on) | |
6644 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message. | |
6645 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn"). | |
6646 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search | |
16610 | 6647 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages; when using the search |
6648 count do not show "W" after the count message (see S below) | |
7 | 6649 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit |
6650 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column. | |
6651 Ignored in Ex mode. | |
6652 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to | |
233 | 6653 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle. |
7 | 6654 Ignored in Ex mode. |
6655 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file | |
6656 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file | |
6657 is found. | |
6658 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|. | |
5946 | 6659 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example, |
6660 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match", | |
6661 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc. | |
8560
f3c636c673f7
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/426dd0219512af5f4abeb0901b533159253ffba3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8497
diff
changeset
|
6662 q use "recording" instead of "recording @a" |
f3c636c673f7
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/426dd0219512af5f4abeb0901b533159253ffba3
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8497
diff
changeset
|
6663 F don't give the file info when editing a file, like `:silent` |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
6664 was used for the command; note that this also affects messages |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
6665 from autocommands |
16533
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
6666 S do not show search count message when searching, e.g. |
5e25171e0e75
patch 8.1.1270: cannot see current match position
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16447
diff
changeset
|
6667 "[1/5]" |
7 | 6668 |
6669 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers | |
6670 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as | |
6671 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you | |
6672 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!" | |
6673 Useful values: | |
6674 shm= No abbreviation of message. | |
6675 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information. | |
6676 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary. | |
6677 | |
6678 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
6679 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6680 | |
6681 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'* | |
6682 'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off) | |
6683 local to buffer | |
6684 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3 | |
6685 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this | |
6686 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when | |
6687 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available | |
6688 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful | |
6689 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos | |
6690 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this | |
6691 option is always on by default. | |
6692 | |
6693 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595* | |
6694 'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "") | |
6695 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6696 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak| |
7 | 6697 feature} |
6698 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6699 values are "> " or "+++ ": > |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6700 :set showbreak=>\ |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6701 < Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6702 this: > |
2314
233eb4412f5d
Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2302
diff
changeset
|
6703 :let &showbreak = '+++ ' |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6704 < Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and |
7 | 6705 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the |
6706 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line). | |
6707 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in | |
6708 'highlight'. | |
6709 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently. | |
6710 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the | |
6711 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'. | |
6712 | |
6713 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'* | |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6714 'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, |
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
6715 Vi default: off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 6716 global |
6717 {not available when compiled without the | |
6718 |+cmdline_info| feature} | |
1152 | 6719 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this |
6720 option off if your terminal is slow. | |
7 | 6721 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown: |
6722 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters. | |
2324
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
6723 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6" |
0a258a67051d
In Visual mode with 'showcmd' display the number of bytes and characters.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2317
diff
changeset
|
6724 means two characters and six bytes. |
7 | 6725 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines. |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6726 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
6727 {lines}x{columns}. |
7 | 6728 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
6729 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6730 | |
6731 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'* | |
6732 'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off) | |
6733 global | |
6734 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the | |
6735 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search | |
10 | 6736 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have |
7 | 6737 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are |
6738 required (coding style permitting). | |
1621 | 6739 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in |
6740 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not | |
6741 match the typed text. | |
7 | 6742 |
6743 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'* | |
6744 'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off) | |
6745 global | |
6746 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The | |
6747 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to | |
6748 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'. | |
6749 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6750 seen or not). |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6751 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6752 reset. |
7 | 6753 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character |
6754 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs. | |
6755 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and | |
6756 blinking when showing the match. | |
6757 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show | |
6758 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite | |
6759 matches. | |
699 | 6760 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving |
6761 around |pi_paren.txt|. | |
6762 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG. | |
7 | 6763 |
6764 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'* | |
6765 'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
6766 global | |
6767 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line. | |
6768 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for | |
6769 this message. | |
10 | 6770 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this |
7 | 6771 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is |
6772 not set. | |
6773 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
6774 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
6775 | |
677 | 6776 *'showtabline'* *'stal'* |
6777 'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1) | |
6778 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
6779 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
677 | 6780 feature} |
6781 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels | |
6782 will be displayed: | |
6783 0: never | |
6784 1: only if there are at least two tab pages | |
6785 2: always | |
6786 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages | |
6787 line. | |
6788 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages. | |
6789 | |
7 | 6790 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'* |
6791 'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0) | |
6792 global | |
6793 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when | |
6794 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen. | |
6795 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen. | |
6796 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using | |
6797 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl" | |
6798 commands. | |
6799 | |
6800 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'* | |
6801 'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0) | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6802 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 6803 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the |
534 | 6804 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a |
6805 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero | |
6806 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in | |
6807 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option | |
6808 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor | |
6809 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too | |
6810 close to the beginning of the line. | |
15713
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6811 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6812 these two: > |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6813 setlocal sidescrolloff< |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6814 setlocal sidescrolloff=-1 |
ad8b2c109b22
patch 8.1.0864: cannot have a local value for 'scrolloff' and 'sidescrolloff'
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15701
diff
changeset
|
6815 < NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 6816 |
6817 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as | |
6818 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6819 onto the "extends" character: > |
7 | 6820 |
6821 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:< | |
6822 :set sidescrolloff=1 | |
9852
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6823 < |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6824 *'signcolumn'* *'scl'* |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6825 'signcolumn' 'scl' string (default "auto") |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6826 local to window |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6827 {not available when compiled without the |+signs| |
4eea48b76d03
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/95ec9d6a6ab3117d60ff638670a803d43974ba51
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9737
diff
changeset
|
6828 feature} |
9860
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6829 Whether or not to draw the signcolumn. Valid values are: |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6830 "auto" only when there is a sign to display |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6831 "no" never |
9eaf8ef656e9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0952131376a517fc12dc5ae908a97018b4ee23f0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9852
diff
changeset
|
6832 "yes" always |
17129
4fb68abc770f
patch 8.1.1564: sign column takes up space
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16808
diff
changeset
|
6833 "number" display signs in the 'number' column. If the number |
17161 | 6834 column is not present, then behaves like "auto". |
7 | 6835 |
6836 | |
6837 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'* | |
6838 'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off) | |
6839 global | |
6840 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper | |
6841 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and | |
6842 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N", | |
3557 | 6843 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After |
7 | 6844 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command, |
6845 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>. | |
6846 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
6847 | |
6848 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'* | |
6849 'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off) | |
6850 local to buffer | |
6851 {not available when compiled without the | |
6852 |+smartindent| feature} | |
6853 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like | |
6854 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does | |
6855 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict, | |
2662 | 6856 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set, |
2642 | 6857 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced |
6858 alternative. | |
7 | 6859 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'. |
6860 An indent is automatically inserted: | |
6861 - After a line ending in '{'. | |
6862 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'. | |
6863 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command). | |
6864 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is | |
6865 given the same indent as the matching '{'. | |
6866 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for | |
6867 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent | |
10 | 6868 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this |
7 | 6869 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H. |
6870 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted | |
6871 right. | |
11160 | 6872 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6873 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6874 reset. |
7 | 6875 |
6876 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'* | |
6877 'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off) | |
6878 global | |
6879 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to | |
648 | 6880 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A |
6881 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the | |
6882 line. | |
650 | 6883 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or |
648 | 6884 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or |
6885 right |shift-left-right|. | |
1263 | 6886 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab' |
7 | 6887 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the |
11 | 6888 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6889 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6890 reset. |
7 | 6891 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
6892 | |
6893 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'* | |
6894 'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0) | |
6895 local to buffer | |
6896 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing | |
6897 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like | |
6898 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is | |
6899 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value | |
6900 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However, | |
6901 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters. | |
6902 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off. | |
3893 | 6903 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used. |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6904 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
6905 when 'paste' is reset. |
7 | 6906 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of |
6907 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s. | |
6908 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is | |
6909 set. | |
6910 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. | |
6911 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6912 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6913 'softtabstop' will be ignored if |'varsofttabstop'| is set to |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6914 anything other than an empty string. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
6915 |
221 | 6916 *'spell'* *'nospell'* |
6917 'spell' boolean (default off) | |
6918 local to window | |
6919 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6920 feature} | |
6921 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|. | |
236 | 6922 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'. |
221 | 6923 |
386 | 6924 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'* |
389 | 6925 'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+") |
386 | 6926 local to buffer |
6927 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6928 feature} | |
6929 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be | |
6930 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted | |
484 | 6931 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled). |
386 | 6932 When this check is not wanted make this option empty. |
6933 Only used when 'spell' is set. | |
389 | 6934 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about |
6935 including spaces and backslashes. | |
480 | 6936 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see |
6937 |set-spc-auto|. | |
386 | 6938 |
314 | 6939 *'spellfile'* *'spf'* |
6940 'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty) | |
6941 local to buffer | |
6942 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6943 feature} | |
6944 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw| | |
401 | 6945 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the |
6946 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory. | |
386 | 6947 *E765* |
6948 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the | |
6949 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using | |
6950 a personal word list file and a project word list file. | |
314 | 6951 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for |
819 | 6952 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If |
6953 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file | |
6954 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used, | |
353 | 6955 ignoring the region. |
6956 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not | |
6957 have to appear in 'spelllang'. | |
6958 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region | |
6959 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when | |
6960 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files | |
6961 without region name will be found. | |
336 | 6962 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
6963 security reasons. | |
314 | 6964 |
221 | 6965 *'spelllang'* *'spl'* |
314 | 6966 'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en") |
221 | 6967 local to buffer |
6968 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
6969 feature} | |
353 | 6970 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is |
6971 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: > | |
6972 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical | |
6973 < This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words | |
6974 that are not recognized will be highlighted. | |
16380 | 6975 The word list name must consist of alphanumeric characters, a dash or |
6976 an underscore. It should not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is | |
353 | 6977 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a |
6978 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words. | |
6979 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is | |
6980 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one | |
6981 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian | |
6982 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great | |
7477
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
6983 Britain. (Note: currently en_au and en_nz dictionaries are older than |
05cf4cc72a9f
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/fa7353428f705f7a13465a1943dddeede4083023
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7272
diff
changeset
|
6984 en_ca, en_gb and en_us). |
5477 | 6985 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from |
6986 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian | |
6987 words. | |
484 | 6988 *E757* |
419 | 6989 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The |
6990 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name | |
6991 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter). | |
6992 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct | |
6993 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it. | |
236 | 6994 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good |
419 | 6995 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the |
6996 files twice. | |
353 | 6997 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|. |
221 | 6998 |
653 | 6999 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name |
7000 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin | |
7001 will ask you if you want to download the file. | |
7002 | |
480 | 7003 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files |
7004 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang' | |
15068 | 7005 up to the first character that is not an ASCII letter or number and |
7006 not a dash. Also see |set-spc-auto|. | |
480 | 7007 |
7008 | |
344 | 7009 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'* |
7010 'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best") | |
7011 global | |
7012 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7013 feature} | |
593 | 7014 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and |
374 | 7015 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of |
7016 items: | |
7017 | |
7018 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds | |
7019 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like | |
7020 scoring to improve the ordering. | |
7021 | |
7022 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the | |
7023 results. The first method is "fast", the other method | |
344 | 7024 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad |
374 | 7025 word. That only works when the language specifies |
7026 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give | |
7027 better results. | |
7028 | |
7029 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes: | |
7030 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for | |
7031 simple typing mistakes. | |
7032 | |
593 | 7033 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|. |
484 | 7034 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of |
7035 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines' | |
7036 minus two. | |
7037 | |
374 | 7038 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns, |
7039 separated by a slash. The first column contains the | |
7040 bad word, the second column the suggested good word. | |
7041 Example: | |
7042 theribal/terrible ~ | |
7043 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the | |
7044 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods. | |
7045 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for | |
7046 comments. | |
5862 | 7047 The word in the second column must be correct, |
7048 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an | |
7049 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling | |
7050 mistake. | |
374 | 7051 The file is used for all languages. |
7052 | |
7053 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid | |
7054 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled | |
7055 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of | |
7056 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score. | |
7057 Example: | |
11062 | 7058 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]] ~ |
593 | 7059 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the |
374 | 7060 internal methods use. A lower score is better. |
7061 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily | |
7062 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part. | |
7063 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the | |
7064 'verbose' option to a non-zero value. | |
7065 | |
7066 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may | |
7067 appear several times in any order. Example: > | |
7068 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest() | |
7069 < | |
7070 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
7071 security reasons. | |
344 | 7072 |
7073 | |
7 | 7074 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'* |
7075 'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off) | |
7076 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7077 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 7078 feature} |
7079 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current | |
7080 one. |:split| | |
7081 | |
7082 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'* | |
7083 'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off) | |
7084 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7085 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 7086 feature} |
7087 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the | |
7088 current one. |:vsplit| | |
7089 | |
7090 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'* | |
7091 'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on) | |
7092 global | |
7093 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first | |
11 | 7094 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column |
10 | 7095 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B, |
11 | 7096 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>" |
7 | 7097 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing |
7098 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that | |
7099 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+". | |
7100 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column | |
7101 where it was the last time the buffer was edited. | |
7102 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set. | |
7103 | |
2709 | 7104 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542* |
7 | 7105 'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty) |
40 | 7106 global or local to window |global-local| |
7 | 7107 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| |
7108 feature} | |
7109 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line. | |
7110 Also see |status-line|. | |
7111 | |
7112 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with | |
7113 normal text. Each status line item is of the form: | |
7114 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item} | |
7876
93f747af7b58
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5e9b2fa9bb0e6061cf18457c173cd141a5dc9c92
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7687
diff
changeset
|
7115 All fields except the {item} are optional. A single percent sign can |
2709 | 7116 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified. *E541* |
7 | 7117 |
680 | 7118 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression, |
7119 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: > | |
7120 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine() | |
16740
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7121 < The *g:statusline_winid* variable will be set to the |window-ID| of the |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7122 window that the status line belongs to. |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7123 The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too. |
3445 | 7124 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the |
7125 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the | |
7126 context of the window that the statusline belongs to. | |
680 | 7127 |
7128 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made | |
7129 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop. | |
7130 | |
7 | 7131 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and |
7132 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|. | |
7133 | |
7134 field meaning ~ | |
233 | 7135 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified |
7 | 7136 when minwid is larger than the length of the item. |
233 | 7137 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'. |
7 | 7138 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'. |
7139 Value must be 50 or less. | |
10 | 7140 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<' |
7 | 7141 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be |
7142 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number | |
7143 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like | |
7144 an exponential notation. | |
7145 item A one letter code as described below. | |
7146 | |
7147 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The | |
7148 second character in "item" is the type: | |
7149 N for number | |
7150 S for string | |
7151 F for flags as described below | |
7152 - not applicable | |
7153 | |
7154 item meaning ~ | |
1152 | 7155 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current |
7156 directory. | |
7 | 7157 F S Full path to the file in the buffer. |
7158 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer. | |
1698 | 7159 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off. |
7 | 7160 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-". |
1698 | 7161 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]". |
7 | 7162 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO". |
1698 | 7163 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]". |
7 | 7164 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP". |
1698 | 7165 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]". |
7 | 7166 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV". |
1698 | 7167 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'. |
7 | 7168 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'. |
2411
68e394361ca3
Add "q" item for 'statusline'. Add w:quickfix_title. (Lech Lorens)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2400
diff
changeset
|
7169 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty. |
7 | 7170 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are |
7171 being used: "<keymap>" | |
7172 n N Buffer number. | |
2709 | 7173 b N Value of character under cursor. |
7 | 7174 B N As above, in hexadecimal. |
7175 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1. | |
7176 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added) | |
7177 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature} | |
7178 O N As above, in hexadecimal. | |
233 | 7179 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.) |
7 | 7180 l N Line number. |
7181 L N Number of lines in buffer. | |
7182 c N Column number. | |
7183 v N Virtual column number. | |
10 | 7184 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'. |
7 | 7185 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|. |
7186 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the | |
5055 | 7187 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless |
7188 translated. | |
233 | 7189 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max}) |
7 | 7190 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one. |
680 | 7191 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result. |
13742
a34b1323286c
patch 8.0.1743: terminal window options are named inconsistently
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13735
diff
changeset
|
7192 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'. The |
a34b1323286c
patch 8.0.1743: terminal window options are named inconsistently
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13735
diff
changeset
|
7193 expression cannot contain a '}' character, call a function to |
a34b1323286c
patch 8.0.1743: terminal window options are named inconsistently
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13735
diff
changeset
|
7194 work around that. |
7 | 7195 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and |
7196 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere. | |
7197 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed. | |
681 | 7198 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last |
7199 label. This information is used for mouse clicks. | |
7200 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the | |
7201 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab" | |
7202 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks. | |
7 | 7203 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start. |
7204 No width fields allowed. | |
7205 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items. | |
7206 No width fields allowed. | |
680 | 7207 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again. |
7208 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same | |
7209 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current | |
7210 windows. | |
7 | 7211 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the |
233 | 7212 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*. |
7 | 7213 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied |
7214 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows. | |
7215 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9| | |
7216 | |
1698 | 7217 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when |
7218 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display | |
7219 when flags are used like in the examples below. | |
7 | 7220 |
233 | 7221 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are |
7 | 7222 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will |
7223 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear | |
7224 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. > | |
7225 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)... | |
16740
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7226 < Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7227 line is displayed. |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7228 *g:actual_curbuf* *g:actual_curwin* |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7229 The current buffer and current window will be set temporarily to that |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7230 of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is currently being drawn. |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7231 The expression will evaluate in this context. The variable |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7232 "g:actual_curbuf" is set to the `bufnr()` number of the real current |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7233 buffer and "g:actual_curwin" to the |window-ID| of the real current |
dc85d49349f7
patch 8.1.1372: when evaluating 'statusline' the current window is unknown
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16728
diff
changeset
|
7234 window. These values are strings. |
634 | 7235 |
3682 | 7236 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from |
7237 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
7238 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
634 | 7239 |
7240 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while | |
7241 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|. | |
7 | 7242 |
7243 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting | |
7244 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by | |
7245 setting an option without changing its value. Example: > | |
7246 :let &ro = &ro | |
7247 | |
7248 < A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes. | |
7249 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules | |
7250 described above. | |
7251 | |
199 | 7252 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable! |
7 | 7253 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
7254 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim --clean" to get it right. |
7 | 7255 |
7256 Examples: | |
7257 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set > | |
7258 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P | |
7259 < Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") > | |
7260 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P | |
7261 < Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. > | |
7262 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b' | |
7263 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red | |
7264 < Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded > | |
7265 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h... | |
7266 < In the |:autocmd|'s: > | |
7267 :let b:gzflag = 1 | |
7268 < And: > | |
7269 :unlet b:gzflag | |
7270 < And define this function: > | |
7271 :function VarExists(var, val) | |
7272 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif | |
7273 :endfunction | |
7274 < | |
7275 *'suffixes'* *'su'* | |
7276 'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj") | |
7277 global | |
7278 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files | |
7279 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the | |
10 | 7280 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as |
7281 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a | |
7 | 7282 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about |
7283 including spaces and backslashes). | |
7284 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files. | |
7285 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7286 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7287 uses another default. | |
7288 | |
7289 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'* | |
7290 'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "") | |
7291 local to buffer | |
7292 {not available when compiled without the | |
7293 |+file_in_path| feature} | |
7294 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a | |
7295 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: > | |
7296 :set suffixesadd=.java | |
7297 < | |
7298 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'* | |
7299 'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on) | |
7300 local to buffer | |
10 | 7301 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a |
7 | 7302 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with |
7303 confidential information that even root must not be able to access. | |
7304 Careful: All text will be in memory: | |
7305 - Don't use this for big files. | |
7306 - Recovery will be impossible! | |
7307 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and | |
7308 'swapfile' is set. | |
7309 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is | |
7310 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is | |
7311 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created. | |
7312 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|. | |
5763 | 7313 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it, |
7314 use the |:noswapfile| modifier. | |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7315 See 'directory' for where the swap file is created. |
7 | 7316 |
7317 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to | |
7318 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|. | |
7319 | |
7320 *'swapsync'* *'sws'* | |
7321 'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync") | |
7322 global | |
7323 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after | |
10 | 7324 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems. |
7 | 7325 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and |
7326 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work. | |
7327 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it, | |
7328 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some | |
7329 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system | |
7330 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default | |
7331 fsync(), which may work better on some systems. | |
36 | 7332 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file. |
7 | 7333 |
7334 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'* | |
7335 'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "") | |
7336 global | |
7337 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers. | |
7338 Possible values (comma separated list): | |
7339 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that | |
7340 contains the specified buffer (if there is one). | |
7341 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows. | |
7342 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when | |
7343 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is | |
7344 also used in all buffer related split commands, for | |
7345 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind". | |
825 | 7346 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab |
856 | 7347 pages. |
7 | 7348 split If included, split the current window before loading |
3153 | 7349 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors. |
16086 | 7350 Otherwise: do not split, use current window (when used |
7351 in the quickfix window: the previously used window or | |
7352 split if there is no other window). | |
6843 | 7353 vsplit Just like "split" but split vertically. |
1621 | 7354 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules |
2290
22529abcd646
Fixed ":s" message. Docs updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2283
diff
changeset
|
7355 "split" when both are present. |
7 | 7356 |
410 | 7357 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'* |
7358 'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000) | |
7359 local to buffer | |
7360 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7361 feature} | |
419 | 7362 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the |
7363 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not | |
7364 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared. | |
410 | 7365 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one |
7366 long line. | |
7367 Set to zero to remove the limit. | |
7368 | |
7 | 7369 *'syntax'* *'syn'* |
7370 'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty) | |
7371 local to buffer | |
7372 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax| | |
7373 feature} | |
7374 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless | |
7375 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off". | |
7376 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the | |
7377 b:current_syntax variable does). | |
7378 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is | |
782 | 7379 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file: |
7380 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~ | |
7381 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype | |
7382 names. Example: | |
7383 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~ | |
7384 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax. | |
7385 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition, | |
7386 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear. | |
7387 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: > | |
7 | 7388 :set syntax=OFF |
7389 < To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the | |
7390 'filetype' option: > | |
7391 :set syntax=ON | |
7392 < What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the | |
7393 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument. | |
7394 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or | |
7395 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'. | |
36 | 7396 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal. |
7 | 7397 |
699 | 7398 *'tabline'* *'tal'* |
677 | 7399 'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty) |
674 | 7400 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7401 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
674 | 7402 feature} |
677 | 7403 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages |
7404 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default | |
681 | 7405 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info. |
677 | 7406 |
7407 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline' | |
688 | 7408 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in |
7409 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used | |
2572
ee53a39d5896
Last changes for the 7.3 release!
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2570
diff
changeset
|
7410 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different. |
677 | 7411 |
7412 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use | |
7413 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out | |
681 | 7414 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for |
7415 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels. | |
677 | 7416 |
15396
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7417 When changing something that is used in 'tabline' that does not |
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7418 trigger it to be updated, use |:redrawtabline|. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
7419 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
15396
325e4a8ba1b6
patch 8.1.0706: tabline is not always redrawn
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15281
diff
changeset
|
7420 |
677 | 7421 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others |
7422 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows. | |
7423 | |
674 | 7424 |
699 | 7425 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'* |
7426 'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10) | |
7427 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
7428 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
699 | 7429 feature} |
7430 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line | |
7431 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage| | |
7432 | |
7433 | |
7434 *'tabstop'* *'ts'* | |
7 | 7435 'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8) |
7436 local to buffer | |
7437 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see | |
7438 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option. | |
7439 | |
7440 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file | |
7441 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it). | |
7442 | |
7443 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim: | |
7444 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4 | |
7445 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim | |
1263 | 7446 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will |
7 | 7447 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters. |
7448 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use | |
7449 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The | |
7450 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed. | |
7451 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a | |
10 | 7452 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only |
7 | 7453 works when using Vim to edit the file. |
7454 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and | |
7455 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only) | |
7456 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have | |
7457 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this | |
7458 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is | |
7459 changed. | |
7460 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7461 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7462 'tabstop' will be ignored if |'vartabstop'| is set to anything other |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7463 than an empty string. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
7464 |
7 | 7465 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'* |
7466 'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on) | |
7467 global | |
7468 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either | |
10 | 7469 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary |
7 | 7470 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search |
7471 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted. | |
7472 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that | |
7473 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the | |
7474 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off. | |
7475 | |
7476 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags | |
10 | 7477 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for |
7 | 7478 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When |
7479 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done. | |
7480 | |
7481 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line | |
7482 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: > | |
1621 | 7483 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/ |
7 | 7484 < [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>] |
7485 | |
7486 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7487 files listed in 'tags', and case is ignored or a pattern is used |
7 | 7488 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search. |
7489 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only | |
7490 be found in the retry. | |
7491 | |
22 | 7492 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second, |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7493 linear search can be avoided when case is ignored. Use a value of '2' |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7494 in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be case-fold |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7495 sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in the command: |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7496 "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version 5.x or higher |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7497 (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used for this as |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7498 well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work. |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7499 |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7500 By default, tag searches are case-sensitive. Case is ignored when |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7501 'ignorecase' is set and 'tagcase' is "followic", or when 'tagcase' is |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7502 "ignore". |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7503 Also when 'tagcase' is "followscs" and 'smartcase' is set, or |
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7504 'tagcase' is "smart", and the pattern contains only lowercase |
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7505 characters. |
7 | 7506 |
7507 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match | |
7508 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags | |
7509 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off. | |
7510 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on | |
7511 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above | |
7512 must be included in the tags file. | |
7513 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g., | |
7514 command-line completion and ":help"). | |
7515 | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7516 *'tagcase'* *'tc'* |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7517 'tagcase' 'tc' string (default "followic") |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7518 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7519 This option specifies how case is handled when searching the tags |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7520 file: |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7521 followic Follow the 'ignorecase' option |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7522 followscs Follow the 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7523 ignore Ignore case |
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7524 match Match case |
9913
bb00c661b3a4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/66e29d7112e437b2b50efe1f82c7e892736d23e4
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9887
diff
changeset
|
7525 smart Ignore case unless an upper case letter is used |
11160 | 7526 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
7527 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7266
6ba7182fb7bd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/0f6562e9036f889185dff49a75c7fc5ffb28b307
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7245
diff
changeset
|
7528 |
16447
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7529 *'tagfunc'* *'tfu'* |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7530 'tagfunc' 'tfu' string (default: empty) |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7531 local to buffer |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7532 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7533 feature} |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7534 This option specifies a function to be used to perform tag searches. |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7535 The function gets the tag pattern and should return a List of matching |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7536 tags. See |tag-function| for an explanation of how to write the |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7537 function and an example. |
54ffc82f38a8
patch 8.1.1228: not possible to process tags with a function
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16443
diff
changeset
|
7538 |
7 | 7539 *'taglength'* *'tl'* |
7540 'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0) | |
7541 global | |
7542 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters. | |
7543 | |
7544 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'* | |
7545 'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
7546 global | |
824 | 7547 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that |
7548 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is. | |
7 | 7549 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
7550 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7551 | |
7552 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433* | |
7553 'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with | |
7554 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS") | |
7555 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
7556 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To | |
7557 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash | |
7558 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes). | |
7559 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path | |
7560 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in | |
7561 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see | |
7562 |tags-option|. | |
7563 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in | |
2522
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7564 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7565 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7566 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7567 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the |
d7ecfc8b784c
Update help about wildcards in 'tags' option.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2492
diff
changeset
|
7568 |+path_extra| feature} |
515 | 7569 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names |
7570 actually used. | |
7 | 7571 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag |
7572 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The | |
7573 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case | |
7574 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags| | |
7575 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7576 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7577 uses another default. | |
7578 | |
7579 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'* | |
7580 'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on) | |
7581 global | |
7582 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or | |
7583 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the | |
7584 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or | |
7585 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified | |
7586 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry. | |
7587 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a | |
7588 mapping which should not change the tagstack. | |
7589 | |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7590 *'tcldll'* |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
7591 'tcldll' string (default depends on the build) |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7592 global |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7593 {only available when compiled with the |+tcl/dyn| |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7594 feature} |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7595 Specifies the name of the Tcl shared library. The default is |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7596 DYNAMIC_TCL_DLL, which was specified at compile time. |
8951
0bdeaf7092bc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/aa3b15dbebf333282503d6031e2f9ba6ee4398ed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8876
diff
changeset
|
7597 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
7538
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7598 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7599 security reasons. |
c9fc24b76293
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8a5115cf18751022387af2085f374d38c60dde83
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7528
diff
changeset
|
7600 |
7 | 7601 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531* |
7602 'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails: | |
7603 in the GUI: "builtin_gui" | |
7604 on Amiga: "amiga" | |
7605 on BeOS: "beos-ansi" | |
7606 on Mac: "mac-ansi" | |
7607 on MiNT: "vt52" | |
7608 on MS-DOS: "pcterm" | |
7609 on OS/2: "os2ansi" | |
7610 on Unix: "ansi" | |
7611 on VMS: "ansi" | |
7612 on Win 32: "win32") | |
7613 global | |
7614 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control | |
7615 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. | |
7616 For example: > | |
7617 :set term=$TERM | |
7618 < See |termcap|. | |
7619 | |
7620 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'* | |
7621 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'* | |
7622 'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm") | |
7623 global | |
7624 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic| | |
7625 feature} | |
7626 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified | |
7627 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping | |
7628 that some languages (such as Arabic) require. | |
7629 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when | |
7630 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored. | |
7631 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that | |
7632 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically. | |
7633 This option is reset when the GUI is started. | |
7634 For further details see |arabic.txt|. | |
7635 | |
7636 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'* | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
7637 'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ GUI: "utf-8"; with |
7 | 7638 Macintosh GUI: "macroman") |
7639 global | |
7640 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character | |
7641 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For | |
8629
54ac275e3fc4
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/3848e00e0177abdb31bc600234967863ec487233
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8560
diff
changeset
|
7642 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the |
1152 | 7643 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then |
7644 'termencoding' should be "macroman". | |
7 | 7645 *E617* |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
7646 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ GUI. After the GUI has been |
7 | 7647 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8". |
7648 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error | |
7649 message is shown. | |
7080
1a34f5272977
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ac360bf2ca293735fc7c6654dc2b3066f4c62488
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7051
diff
changeset
|
7650 For the Win32 GUI and console versions 'termencoding' is not used, |
7 | 7651 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters. |
7652 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option. | |
7653 This is the normal value. | |
7654 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See | |
7655 |encoding-table|. | |
7656 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or | |
7657 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you | |
7658 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters. | |
7659 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and | |
7660 want to edit a UTF-8 file: > | |
7661 :let &termencoding = &encoding | |
7662 :set encoding=utf-8 | |
7663 < You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8. | |
7664 | |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7665 *'termguicolors'* *'tgc'* *E954* |
9027
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7666 'termguicolors' 'tgc' boolean (default off) |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7667 global |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7668 {not available when compiled without the |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7669 |+termguicolors| feature} |
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7670 When on, uses |highlight-guifg| and |highlight-guibg| attributes in |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7671 the terminal (thus using 24-bit color). |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7672 |
13314
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7673 Requires a ISO-8613-3 compatible terminal. If setting this option |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7674 does not work (produces a colorless UI) reading |xterm-true-color| |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7675 might help. |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7676 |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7677 For Win32 console, Windows 10 version 1703 (Creators Update) or later |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7678 is required. Use this check to find out: > |
65c3e8259124
patch 8.0.1531: cannot use 24 bit colors in MS-Windows console
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13234
diff
changeset
|
7679 if has('vcon') |
13341
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7680 < This requires Vim to be built with the |+vtp| feature. |
acd7eaa13d2b
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13314
diff
changeset
|
7681 |
11473 | 7682 Note that the "cterm" attributes are still used, not the "gui" ones. |
11160 | 7683 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
9027
773d627cac0b
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/61be73bb0f965a895bfb064ea3e55476ac175162
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8969
diff
changeset
|
7684 |
13735 | 7685 *'termwinkey'* *'twk'* |
7686 'termwinkey' 'twk' string (default "") | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7687 local to window |
11914 | 7688 The key that starts a CTRL-W command in a terminal window. Other keys |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7689 are sent to the job running in the window. |
11914 | 7690 The <> notation can be used, e.g.: > |
13735 | 7691 :set termwinkey=<C-L> |
11914 | 7692 < The string must be one key stroke but can be multiple bytes. |
7693 When not set CTRL-W is used, so that CTRL-W : gets you to the command | |
13735 | 7694 line. If 'termwinkey' is set to CTRL-L then CTRL-L : gets you to the |
11914 | 7695 command line. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7696 |
16443
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7697 *'termwinscroll'* *'twsl'* |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7698 'termwinscroll' 'twsl' number (default 10000) |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7699 local to buffer |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7700 {not available when compiled without the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7701 |+terminal| feature} |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7702 Number of scrollback lines to keep. When going over this limit the |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7703 first 10% of the scrollback lines are deleted. This is just to reduce |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7704 the memory usage. See |Terminal-Normal|. |
32a543152dc0
patch 8.1.1226: {not in Vi} remarks get in the way of useful help text
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16439
diff
changeset
|
7705 |
13735 | 7706 *'termwinsize'* *'tws'* |
7707 'termwinsize' 'tws' string (default "") | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7708 local to window |
13700
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7709 Size of the |terminal| window. Format: {rows}x{columns} or |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7710 {rows}*{columns}. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7711 - When empty the terminal gets the size from the window. |
13700
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7712 - When set with a "x" (e.g., "24x80") the terminal size is not |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7713 adjusted to the window size. If the window is smaller only the |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7714 top-left part is displayed. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7715 - When set with a "*" (e.g., "10*50") the terminal size follows the |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7716 window size, but will not be smaller than the specified rows and/or |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7717 columns. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7718 - When rows is zero then use the height of the window. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7719 - When columns is zero then use the width of the window. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7720 - Using "0x0" or "0*0" is the same as empty. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7721 |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7722 Examples: |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7723 "30x0" uses 30 rows and the current window width. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7724 "20*0" uses at least 20 rows and the current window width. |
b28d679b1843
patch 8.0.1722: cannot specify a minimal size for a terminal window
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
13680
diff
changeset
|
7725 "0*40" uses the current window height and at least 40 columns. |
11757
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7726 Note that the command running in the terminal window may still change |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7727 the size of the terminal. In that case the Vim window will be |
74abb6c84984
patch 8.0.0761: options not set properly for a terminal buffer
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11666
diff
changeset
|
7728 adjusted to that size, if possible. |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
7729 |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7730 *'termwintype'* *'twt'* |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7731 'termwintype' 'twt' string (default "") |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7732 global |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7733 {only available when compiled with the |terminal| |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7734 feature on MS-Windows} |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7735 Specify the virtual console (pty) used when opening the terminal |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7736 window. |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7737 |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7738 Possible values are: |
15804
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7739 "" use ConPTY if it is stable, winpty otherwise |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7740 "winpty" use winpty, fail if not supported |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7741 "conpty" use |ConPTY|, fail if not supported |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7742 |
15804
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7743 |ConPTY| support depends on the platform. Windows 10 October 2018 |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7744 Update is the first version that supports ConPTY, however it is still |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7745 considered unstable. ConPTY might become stable in the next release |
864ec0dd71b9
patch 8.1.0909: MS-Windows: using ConPTY even though it is not stable
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15746
diff
changeset
|
7746 of Windows 10. winpty support needs to be installed. If neither is |
15746
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7747 supported then you cannot open a terminal window. |
c017195b121b
patch 8.1.0880: MS-Windows: inconsistent selection of winpty/conpty
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
15729
diff
changeset
|
7748 |
7 | 7749 *'terse'* *'noterse'* |
7750 'terse' boolean (default off) | |
7751 global | |
7752 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message | |
7753 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being | |
7754 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi | |
7755 shortens a lot of messages} | |
7756 | |
7757 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'* | |
7758 'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off) | |
7759 global | |
7760 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'. | |
7761 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is | |
7762 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is | |
7763 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty. | |
7764 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
7765 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
7766 | |
7767 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'* | |
7768 'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on, | |
7769 others: default off) | |
7770 local to buffer | |
7771 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'. | |
7772 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is | |
7773 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to | |
7774 "unix". | |
7775 | |
7776 *'textwidth'* *'tw'* | |
7777 'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0) | |
7778 local to buffer | |
7779 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be | |
7780 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7781 this. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7782 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7783 when 'paste' is reset. |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
7784 When 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also |
7 | 7785 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. |
838 | 7786 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line. |
7 | 7787 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set. |
7788 | |
7789 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'* | |
7790 'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "") | |
7791 global or local to buffer |global-local| | |
7792 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words | |
15033 | 7793 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. |
7794 | |
7795 Each line in the file should contain words with similar meaning, | |
7796 separated by non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). | |
7797 Maximum line length is 510 bytes. | |
7798 | |
15131 | 7799 An English word list was added to this github issue: |
7800 https://github.com/vim/vim/issues/629#issuecomment-443293282 | |
7801 Unpack thesaurus_pkg.zip, put the thesaurus.txt file somewhere, e.g. | |
7802 ~/.vim/thesaurus/english.txt, and the 'thesaurus' option to this file | |
7803 name. | |
15033 | 7804 |
10 | 7805 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces |
7 | 7806 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file |
7807 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. | |
7808 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
7809 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
7810 uses another default. | |
7811 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons. | |
7812 | |
7813 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'* | |
7814 'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off) | |
7815 global | |
7816 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator. | |
7817 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
7818 | |
7819 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'* | |
7820 'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on) | |
7821 global | |
7822 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'* | |
11400
0f8713fe20dc
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11262
diff
changeset
|
7823 'ttimeout' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 7824 global |
7825 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a | |
7826 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received: | |
7827 | |
7828 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~ | |
7829 off off do not time out | |
7830 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes | |
7831 off on time out on key codes | |
7832 | |
7833 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete | |
7834 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there | |
7835 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For | |
7836 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next | |
7837 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'. | |
7838 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for | |
7839 the next character to arrive. After that the already received | |
7840 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can | |
7841 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option. | |
7842 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause | |
7843 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits | |
7844 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start | |
7845 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have | |
7846 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key | |
7847 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and | |
7848 reset the 'timeout' option. | |
7849 | |
7850 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set. | |
7851 | |
7852 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'* | |
7853 'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000) | |
7854 global | |
16553
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
7855 |
7 | 7856 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'* |
11400
0f8713fe20dc
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11262
diff
changeset
|
7857 'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1, set to 100 in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 7858 global |
7859 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key | |
7860 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G | |
7861 when part of a command has been typed. | |
7862 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a | |
7863 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to | |
7864 a non-negative number. | |
7865 | |
7866 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~ | |
7867 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen' | |
7868 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen' | |
7869 | |
7870 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options | |
7871 tell so. A useful setting would be > | |
7872 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100 | |
7873 < (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after | |
7874 a tenth of a second). | |
7875 | |
7876 *'title'* *'notitle'* | |
7877 'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored) | |
7878 global | |
7879 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7880 feature} | |
7881 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of | |
7882 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to: | |
7883 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM | |
7884 Where: | |
7885 filename the name of the file being edited | |
7886 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off | |
7887 + indicates the file was modified | |
7888 = indicates the file is read-only | |
7889 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified | |
7890 (path) is the path of the file being edited | |
7891 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM" | |
7892 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles | |
7893 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and | |
7894 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and | |
7895 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap). | |
7896 *X11* | |
7897 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will | |
7898 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11" | |
7899 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also | |
7900 works for the icon name |'icon'|. | |
7901 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title | |
7902 will not work (except in the GUI). | |
7903 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'. | |
7904 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then. | |
7905 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command: | |
7906 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY & | |
7907 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the | |
7908 title of the window should change back to what it should be after | |
7909 exiting Vim. | |
7910 | |
7911 *'titlelen'* | |
7912 'titlelen' number (default 85) | |
7913 global | |
7914 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7915 feature} | |
7916 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window | |
10 | 7917 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is |
7918 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this. | |
7 | 7919 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But |
7920 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters | |
7921 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title | |
7922 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise, | |
7923 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used. | |
7924 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option. | |
7925 | |
7926 *'titleold'* | |
7927 'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim") | |
7928 global | |
7929 {only available when compiled with the |+title| | |
7930 feature} | |
7931 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the | |
7932 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or | |
7933 'titlestring' is not empty. | |
36 | 7934 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
7935 security reasons. | |
7 | 7936 *'titlestring'* |
7937 'titlestring' string (default "") | |
7938 global | |
7939 {not available when compiled without the |+title| | |
7940 feature} | |
7941 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the | |
7942 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on. | |
7943 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently | |
7944 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a | |
7945 non-empty 't_ts' option). | |
7946 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will | |
10449
222b1432814e
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/5162822914372fc916a93f85848c0c82209e7cec
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10272
diff
changeset
|
7947 be restored if possible, see |X11|. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
7948 |
7 | 7949 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be |
7950 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. | |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
7951 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off. |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
7952 |
7 | 7953 Example: > |
7954 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p") | |
7955 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70 | |
7956 < The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right | |
7957 of the available space. | |
7958 Some people prefer to have the file name first: > | |
7959 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%) | |
7960 < Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file, | |
10 | 7961 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a |
7 | 7962 separating space only when needed. |
7963 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display | |
7964 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character). | |
7965 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature} | |
7966 | |
7967 *'toolbar'* *'tb'* | |
7968 'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips") | |
7969 global | |
7970 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and | |
7971 |+GUI_Photon|} | |
10 | 7972 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The |
7 | 7973 possible values are: |
7974 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons. | |
7975 text Toolbar buttons shown with text. | |
7976 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are | |
10 | 7977 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI} |
7 | 7978 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons. |
7979 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse | |
7980 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment. | |
7981 | |
7982 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the | |
7983 following: > | |
7984 :set tb=icons,text | |
7985 < Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They | |
7986 will show icons if both are requested. | |
7987 | |
7988 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if | |
7989 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable | |
7990 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: > | |
7991 :set guioptions-=T | |
7992 < Also see |gui-toolbar|. | |
7993 | |
7994 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'* | |
7995 'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small") | |
7996 global | |
10895
c391bfbdb452
Updated runtime files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10734
diff
changeset
|
7997 {only in the GTK+ GUI} |
7 | 7998 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are: |
8497
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
7999 tiny Use tiny icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8000 small Use small icons (default). |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8001 medium Use medium-sized icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8002 large Use large icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8003 huge Use even larger icons. |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8004 giant Use very big icons. |
7 | 8005 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on |
8497
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8006 the current theme. Common dimensions are giant=48x48, huge=32x32, |
da01d5da2cfa
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/77cdfd10382e01cc51f4ba1a9177032351843151
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
8246
diff
changeset
|
8007 large=24x24, medium=24x24, small=20x20 and tiny=16x16. |
7 | 8008 |
8009 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined | |
8010 by user preferences or the current theme is used. | |
8011 | |
8012 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'* | |
8013 'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on) | |
8014 global | |
8015 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones. | |
8016 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones. | |
8017 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for | |
8018 the change to take effect, for example: > | |
8019 :set notbi term=$TERM | |
8020 < See also |termcap|. | |
8021 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin | |
8022 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty | |
8023 xterm entries...). | |
8024 | |
8025 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'* | |
8026 'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm, | |
8027 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or | |
8028 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in | |
8029 a DOS console) | |
8030 global | |
8031 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to | |
8032 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line | |
8033 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple | |
8034 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region. | |
8035 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen | |
8036 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the | |
8037 mouse in an xterm and other terminals. | |
8038 | |
8039 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'* | |
8040 'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term') | |
8041 global | |
8042 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not | |
8043 available when compiled without |+mouse|} | |
8044 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized. | |
1213 | 8045 Currently these strings are valid: |
7 | 8046 *xterm-mouse* |
8047 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates | |
8048 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes: | |
8049 "s" = button state | |
8050 "c" = column plus 33 | |
8051 "r" = row plus 33 | |
5908 | 8052 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec", |
8053 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions. | |
7 | 8054 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the |
8055 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works | |
8056 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at | |
180 | 8057 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to |
7 | 8058 work. See below for how Vim detects this |
8059 automatically. | |
8060 *netterm-mouse* | |
16553
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
8061 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. A left mouse click generates |
7 | 8062 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers |
16553
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
8063 for the row and column. No other mouse events are |
0e473e9e70c2
patch 8.1.1280: remarks about functionality not in Vi clutters the help
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16533
diff
changeset
|
8064 supported. |
7 | 8065 *dec-mouse* |
8066 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a | |
8067 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[". | |
189 | 8068 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was |
8069 configured with "--enable-dec-locator". | |
7 | 8070 *jsbterm-mouse* |
8071 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling. | |
8072 *pterm-mouse* | |
8073 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling. | |
3224 | 8074 *urxvt-mouse* |
8075 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal. | |
5908 | 8076 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this |
8077 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit | |
8078 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2". | |
3750 | 8079 *sgr-mouse* |
8080 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled | |
5908 | 8081 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns |
8082 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with | |
8083 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style | |
8084 mouse codes. | |
7 | 8085 |
8086 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm| | |
5908 | 8087 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt| |
8088 |+mouse_sgr|. | |
7 | 8089 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always |
8090 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes | |
8091 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not | |
5908 | 8092 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict |
8093 with them). | |
7 | 8094 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is |
10272
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8095 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", "screen", "tmux", |
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8096 "st" (full match only), "st-" or "stterm", and 'ttymouse' is not set |
57b2b8268d3a
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/4575876dc865d4160f20d61bd822fbe7cafbec41
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
10261
diff
changeset
|
8097 already. |
5908 | 8098 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and |
8099 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version | |
17229
f1c7b7a4d9e4
patch 8.1.1614: 'numberwidth' can only go up to 10
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
17161
diff
changeset
|
8100 number, more intelligent detection is done. |
7 | 8101 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be |
15131 | 8102 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if Vim detects Mac |
8103 Terminal.app, iTerm2 or mintty, and when the xterm version is 277 or | |
8104 higher. | |
5908 | 8105 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr" |
8106 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: > | |
7 | 8107 :set t_RV= |
8108 < | |
8109 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'* | |
8110 'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999) | |
8111 global | |
8112 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines | |
8113 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is | |
8114 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number, | |
8115 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying. | |
8116 | |
8117 *'ttytype'* *'tty'* | |
8118 'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM) | |
8119 global | |
8120 Alias for 'term', see above. | |
8121 | |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8122 *'undodir'* *'udir'* |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8123 'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".") |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8124 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8125 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature} |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8126 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas. |
2220
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8127 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format. |
2218
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8128 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8129 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~". |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8130 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited |
695ceebf17ca
Fix: :wundo didn't work in a buffer without a name.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2214
diff
changeset
|
8131 file, with path separators replaced with "%". |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8132 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8133 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8134 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8135 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8136 given, no further entry is used. |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8137 See |undo-persistence|. |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8138 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8139 security reasons. |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8140 |
4681
2eb30f341e8d
Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
4502
diff
changeset
|
8141 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'* |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8142 'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off) |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8143 local to buffer |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8144 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature} |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8145 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8146 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same |
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8147 file on buffer read. |
2220
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8148 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'. |
b1c70c500de4
Found a way to make the MS-Windows installer wait for the uninstaller to
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2218
diff
changeset
|
8149 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|. |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8150 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8151 before a reload to be saved for undo. |
3920 | 8152 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted. |
11160 | 8153 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set. |
2214
f8222d1f9a73
Included patch for persistent undo. Lots of changes and added test.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2209
diff
changeset
|
8154 |
7 | 8155 *'undolevels'* *'ul'* |
8156 'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS, | |
8157 Win32 and OS/2) | |
5446 | 8158 global or local to buffer |global-local| |
7 | 8159 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information |
8160 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used | |
8161 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory). | |
8162 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes | |
8163 itself: > | |
8164 set ul=0 | |
8165 < But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in | |
8166 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo. | |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2240
diff
changeset
|
8167 Also see |undo-two-ways|. |
5446 | 8168 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the |
8169 current buffer: > | |
8170 setlocal ul=-1 | |
7 | 8171 < This helps when you run out of memory for a single change. |
6336 | 8172 |
8173 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used. | |
8174 | |
2249
6d3d35ff2c2b
Use full path in undofile(). Updated docs.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2240
diff
changeset
|
8175 Also see |clear-undo|. |
7 | 8176 |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8177 *'undoreload'* *'ur'* |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8178 'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000) |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8179 global |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8180 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8181 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8182 Vim. |FileChangedShell| |
12559 | 8183 The save only happens when this option is negative or when the number |
2394
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8184 of lines is smaller than the value of this option. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8185 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8186 |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8187 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read. |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8188 |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8189 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set |
a3aca345aafa
Add the 'undoreload' option to be able to undo a file reload.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2382
diff
changeset
|
8190 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory. |
7 | 8191 |
8192 *'updatecount'* *'uc'* | |
8193 'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200) | |
8194 global | |
8195 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to | |
8196 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on | |
8197 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting | |
8198 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly | |
8199 mode this option will be initialized to 10000. | |
8200 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|. | |
8201 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are | |
8202 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount' | |
8203 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted. | |
8204 Also see |'swapsync'|. | |
8205 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile" | |
8206 or "nowrite". | |
8207 | |
8208 *'updatetime'* *'ut'* | |
8209 'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000) | |
8210 global | |
8211 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be | |
8212 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the | |
8213 |CursorHold| autocommand event. | |
8214 | |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8215 *'varsofttabstop'* *'vsts'* |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8216 'varsofttabstop' 'vsts' string (default "") |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8217 local to buffer |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8218 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs| |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8219 feature} |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8220 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while editing, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8221 such as inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like variable- |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8222 width <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mixture of spaces |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8223 and <Tab>s is used. Tab widths are separated with commas, with the |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8224 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8225 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8226 For example, when editing assembly language files where statements |
14249
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8227 start in the 9th column and comments in the 41st, it may be useful |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8228 to use the following: > |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8229 :set varsofttabstop=8,32,8 |
14249
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8230 < This will set soft tabstops with 8 and 8 + 32 spaces, and 8 more |
4543777545a3
Updated runtime and language files.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14175
diff
changeset
|
8231 for every column thereafter. |
14175
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8232 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8233 Note that the value of |'softtabstop'| will be ignored while |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8234 'varsofttabstop' is set. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8235 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8236 *'vartabstop'* *'vts'* |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8237 'vartabstop' 'vts' string (default "") |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8238 local to buffer |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8239 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs| |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8240 feature} |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8241 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8242 separated by commas. Each value corresponds to one tab, with the |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8243 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. For example: > |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8244 :set vartabstop=4,20,10,8 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8245 < This will make the first tab 4 spaces wide, the second 20 spaces, |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8246 the third 10 spaces, and all following tabs 8 spaces. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8247 |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8248 Note that the value of |'tabstop'| will be ignored while 'vartabstop' |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8249 is set. |
2ad722003b36
patch 8.1.0105: all tab stops are the same
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
14019
diff
changeset
|
8250 |
7 | 8251 *'verbose'* *'vbs'* |
8252 'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0) | |
8253 global | |
8254 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing. | |
8255 Currently, these messages are given: | |
8256 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written. | |
8257 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed. | |
712 | 8258 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file. |
7 | 8259 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed. |
8260 >= 9 Every executed autocommand. | |
8261 >= 12 Every executed function. | |
8262 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded. | |
8263 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause. | |
8264 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters). | |
8265 | |
8266 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|. | |
8267 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command. | |
8268 | |
293 | 8269 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not |
8270 displayed. | |
8271 | |
8272 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'* | |
8273 'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty) | |
8274 global | |
8275 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name. | |
8276 When the file exists messages are appended. | |
8277 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made | |
2265
b7cb69ab616d
Added salt to blowfish encryption.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2250
diff
changeset
|
8278 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time. |
293 | 8279 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first. |
8280 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not | |
8281 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set. | |
8282 | |
7 | 8283 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'* |
8284 'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32: | |
8285 "$VIM/vimfiles/view", | |
8286 for Unix: "~/.vim/view", | |
8287 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view" | |
8288 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view" | |
8289 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view") | |
8290 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8291 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 8292 feature} |
8293 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|. | |
8294 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
8295 security reasons. | |
8296 | |
8297 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'* | |
12824
79a754456110
patch 8.0.1289: mkview always includes the local directory
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12802
diff
changeset
|
8298 'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor,curdir") |
7 | 8299 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8300 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession| |
7 | 8301 feature} |
8302 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated | |
10 | 8303 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something: |
7 | 8304 word save and restore ~ |
8305 cursor cursor position in file and in window | |
8306 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local | |
8307 fold options | |
8308 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not | |
8309 global values for local options) | |
6213 | 8310 localoptions same as "options" |
7 | 8311 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward |
8312 slashes | |
8313 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when | |
8314 on Windows or DOS | |
12824
79a754456110
patch 8.0.1289: mkview always includes the local directory
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
12802
diff
changeset
|
8315 curdir the window-local directory, if set with `:lcd` |
7 | 8316 |
8317 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files | |
8318 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts, | |
8319 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts. | |
8320 | |
8321 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528* | |
8322 'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS, | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8323 Windows and OS/2: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:, |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8324 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2: |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8325 for others: '100,<50,s10,h) |
7 | 8326 global |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8327 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo| |
7 | 8328 feature} |
8329 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written | |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8330 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). Except when 'viminfofile' is |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8331 "NONE". |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8332 The string should be a comma separated list of parameters, each |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8333 consisting of a single character identifying the particular parameter, |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8334 followed by a number or string which specifies the value of that |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8335 parameter. If a particular character is left out, then the default |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8336 value is used for that parameter. The following is a list of the |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8337 identifying characters and the effect of their value. |
7 | 8338 CHAR VALUE ~ |
3224 | 8339 *viminfo-!* |
7 | 8340 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start |
8341 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase | |
8342 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis" | |
2607 | 8343 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be |
2642 | 8344 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item. |
3224 | 8345 *viminfo-quote* |
7 | 8346 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of |
8347 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a | |
8348 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the | |
8349 start of a comment! | |
3224 | 8350 *viminfo-%* |
7 | 8351 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is |
8352 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not | |
8353 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the | |
7272
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8354 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Quickfix |
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8355 ('buftype'), unlisted ('buflisted'), unnamed and buffers on |
17333ebd2bbd
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/d042dc825c9b97dacd84d4728f88300da4d5b6b9
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7266
diff
changeset
|
8356 removable media (|viminfo-r|) are not saved. |
23 | 8357 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum |
8358 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all | |
8359 buffers are stored. | |
3224 | 8360 *viminfo-'* |
7 | 8361 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks |
8362 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when | |
8363 'viminfo' is non-empty. | |
8364 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the | |
8365 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file. | |
3224 | 8366 *viminfo-/* |
7 | 8367 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be |
10 | 8368 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute |
7 | 8369 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of |
8370 'history' is used. | |
3224 | 8371 *viminfo-:* |
7 | 8372 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be |
10 | 8373 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used. |
3224 | 8374 *viminfo-<* |
7 | 8375 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then |
8376 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are | |
8377 saved. '"' is the old name for this item. | |
8378 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte. | |
3224 | 8379 *viminfo-@* |
7 | 8380 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be |
10 | 8381 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used. |
3224 | 8382 *viminfo-c* |
7 | 8383 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the |
8384 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current | |
233 | 8385 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|. |
3224 | 8386 *viminfo-f* |
7 | 8387 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0 |
8388 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when | |
10 | 8389 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current |
7 | 8390 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo"). |
3224 | 8391 *viminfo-h* |
7 | 8392 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo |
8393 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch" | |
8394 has been used since the last search command. | |
3224 | 8395 *viminfo-n* |
7 | 8396 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8397 the 'n'. Must be at the end of the option! If the |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8398 'viminfofile' option is set, that file name overrides the one |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8399 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are |
9464
be72f4201a1d
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/063b9d15abea041a5bfff3ffc4e219e26fd1d4fa
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9407
diff
changeset
|
8400 expanded when opening the file, not when setting the option. |
3224 | 8401 *viminfo-r* |
7 | 8402 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next |
8403 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each | |
8404 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be | |
8405 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you | |
8406 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can | |
8407 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is | |
8408 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50 | |
8409 characters. | |
3224 | 8410 *viminfo-s* |
7 | 8411 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are |
8412 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default | |
8413 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text. | |
8414 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit. | |
8415 | |
8416 Example: > | |
8417 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo | |
8418 < | |
8419 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you | |
8420 edited. | |
8421 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be | |
8422 remembered. | |
8423 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped. | |
8424 :0 Command-line history will not be saved. | |
8425 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo". | |
8426 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used, | |
8427 that is, save all of the search history, and also the | |
8428 previous search and substitute patterns. | |
8429 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back. | |
8430 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored. | |
8431 | |
8432 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to | |
8433 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically. | |
8434 | |
8435 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for | |
8436 security reasons. | |
11160 | 8437 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible' |
8438 is reset. | |
7 | 8439 |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8440 *'viminfofile'* *'vif'* |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8441 'viminfofile' 'vif' string (default: "") |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8442 global |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8443 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo| |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8444 feature} |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8445 When non-empty, overrides the file name used for viminfo. |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8446 When equal to "NONE" no viminfo file will be read or written. |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8447 This option can be set with the |-i| command line flag. The |--clean| |
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8448 command line flag sets it to "NONE". |
16728
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8449 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
e55c26aaf484
patch 8.1.1366: using expressions in a modeline is unsafe
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16610
diff
changeset
|
8450 security reasons. |
11666
5cd9ba96561d
patch 8.0.0716: not easy to start Vim cleanly
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11659
diff
changeset
|
8451 |
7 | 8452 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'* |
8453 'virtualedit' 've' string (default "") | |
8454 global | |
8455 {not available when compiled without the | |
8456 |+virtualedit| feature} | |
8457 A comma separated list of these words: | |
8458 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode. | |
8459 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode. | |
8460 all Allow virtual editing in all modes. | |
772 | 8461 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line |
782 | 8462 |
7 | 8463 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is |
1263 | 8464 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end |
7 | 8465 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and |
8466 editing a table. | |
772 | 8467 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just |
8468 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more | |
8469 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line | |
8470 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also | |
782 | 8471 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move |
8472 the cursor after the last character. Use with care! | |
5220 | 8473 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not |
782 | 8474 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left! |
5220 | 8475 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line. |
772 | 8476 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will |
8477 not get a warning for it. | |
11160 | 8478 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set. |
7 | 8479 |
8480 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep* | |
8481 'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off) | |
8482 global | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8483 Use a visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the |
7 | 8484 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted, |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8485 use: > |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8486 :set vb t_vb= |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8487 < If you want a short flash, you can use this on many terminals: > |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8488 :set vb t_vb=[?5h$<100>[?5l |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8489 < Here $<100> specifies the time, you can use a smaller or bigger value |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8490 to get a shorter or longer flash. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8491 |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8492 Note: Vim will limit the bell to once per half a second. This avoids |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8493 having to wait for the flashing to finish when there are lots of |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8494 bells, e.g. on key repeat. This also happens without 'visualbell' |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8495 set. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8496 |
7 | 8497 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display |
8498 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f", | |
8499 where 40 is the time in msec. | |
11659
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8500 |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8501 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8502 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|. |
49c12c93abf3
Updated runtime files and translations.
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11529
diff
changeset
|
8503 |
7 | 8504 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash. |
8505 Also see 'errorbells'. | |
8506 | |
8507 *'warn'* *'nowarn'* | |
8508 'warn' boolean (default on) | |
8509 global | |
8510 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer | |
8511 has been changed. | |
8512 | |
8513 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'* | |
8514 'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off) | |
8515 global | |
667 | 8516 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option. |
7 | 8517 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x. |
8518 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and | |
8519 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running. | |
8520 | |
8521 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'* | |
8522 'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "") | |
8523 global | |
8524 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the | |
8525 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in | |
8526 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys: | |
8527 char key mode ~ | |
8528 b <BS> Normal and Visual | |
8529 s <Space> Normal and Visual | |
712 | 8530 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended) |
8531 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended) | |
7 | 8532 < <Left> Normal and Visual |
8533 > <Right> Normal and Visual | |
8534 ~ "~" Normal | |
8535 [ <Left> Insert and Replace | |
8536 ] <Right> Insert and Replace | |
8537 For example: > | |
8538 :set ww=<,>,[,] | |
8539 < allows wrap only when cursor keys are used. | |
8540 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change | |
8541 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h" | |
8542 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This | |
8543 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and | |
8544 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping | |
8545 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the | |
8546 cursor. | |
714 | 8547 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a |
8548 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl", | |
8549 "yl" etc. work normally. | |
7 | 8550 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is |
8551 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
8552 | |
8553 *'wildchar'* *'wc'* | |
8554 'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E) | |
8555 global | |
8556 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the | |
8557 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'. | |
1621 | 8558 More info here: |cmdline-completion|. |
7 | 8559 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See |
8560 'wildcharm' for that. | |
8561 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: > | |
8562 :set wc=<Esc> | |
8563 < NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is | |
8564 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset. | |
8565 | |
8566 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'* | |
8567 'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0)) | |
8568 global | |
8569 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is | |
233 | 8570 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line |
8571 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally | |
7 | 8572 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that |
8573 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: > | |
8574 :set wcm=<C-Z> | |
1621 | 8575 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z> |
7 | 8576 < Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N. |
8577 | |
8578 *'wildignore'* *'wig'* | |
8579 'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "") | |
8580 global | |
8581 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
8582 feature} | |
8583 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these | |
3682 | 8584 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or |
8585 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and | |
8586 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this. | |
7 | 8587 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|. |
8588 Also see 'suffixes'. | |
8589 Example: > | |
8590 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj | |
8591 < The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing | |
8592 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version | |
8593 uses another default. | |
8594 | |
2652 | 8595 |
2662 | 8596 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'* |
2652 | 8597 'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off) |
8598 global | |
8599 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories. | |
4242 | 8600 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set. |
2652 | 8601 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which |
8602 happens when there are special characters. | |
8603 | |
8604 | |
7 | 8605 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'* |
9669
284b4eb307fc
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/8c08b5b569e2a9e9f63dea514591ecfa2d3bb392
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9665
diff
changeset
|
8606 'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|) |
7 | 8607 global |
8608 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu| | |
8609 feature} | |
8610 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced | |
8611 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion, | |
8612 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the | |
8613 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is | |
8614 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or | |
8615 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match. | |
8616 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is | |
8617 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode. | |
4159 | 8618 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|. |
7 | 8619 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on |
8620 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls | |
8621 as needed. | |
8622 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used | |
8623 for selecting a completion. | |
8624 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special | |
8625 meanings: | |
8626 | |
8627 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N) | |
8628 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a | |
8629 subdirectory or submenu. | |
8630 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a | |
8631 dot: move into a submenu. | |
8632 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into | |
8633 parent directory or parent menu. | |
8634 | |
8635 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|. | |
8636 | |
8637 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead | |
8638 of selecting a different match, use this: > | |
8639 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left> | |
8640 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right> | |
8641 < | |
8642 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match | |
8643 |hl-WildMenu|. | |
8644 | |
8645 *'wildmode'* *'wim'* | |
8646 'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full") | |
8647 global | |
8648 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with | |
10 | 8649 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each |
1152 | 8650 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The |
7 | 8651 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar', |
8652 The second part for the second use, etc. | |
8653 These are the possible values for each part: | |
8654 "" Complete only the first match. | |
8655 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match, | |
8656 the original string is used and then the first match | |
8657 again. | |
8658 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't | |
8659 result in a longer string, use the next part. | |
8660 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is | |
8661 enabled. | |
8662 "list" When more than one match, list all matches. | |
8663 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and | |
8664 complete first match. | |
8665 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and | |
8666 complete till longest common string. | |
8667 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases. | |
8668 | |
8669 Examples: > | |
8670 :set wildmode=full | |
233 | 8671 < Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) > |
7 | 8672 :set wildmode=longest,full |
8673 < Complete longest common string, then each full match > | |
8674 :set wildmode=list:full | |
8675 < List all matches and complete each full match > | |
8676 :set wildmode=list,full | |
8677 < List all matches without completing, then each full match > | |
8678 :set wildmode=longest,list | |
8679 < Complete longest common string, then list alternatives. | |
1621 | 8680 More info here: |cmdline-completion|. |
7 | 8681 |
40 | 8682 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'* |
8683 'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "") | |
8684 global | |
8685 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore| | |
8686 feature} | |
8687 A list of words that change how command line completion is done. | |
8688 Currently only one word is allowed: | |
8689 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of | |
856 | 8690 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match |
40 | 8691 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are: |
8692 d #define | |
8693 f function | |
8694 Also see |cmdline-completion|. | |
8695 | |
7 | 8696 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'* |
8697 'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu") | |
8698 global | |
8699 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI} | |
8700 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT | |
8701 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the | |
8702 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and | |
8703 entering special characters. This option tells what to do: | |
8704 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be | |
8705 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be | |
8706 done with the |:simalt| command. | |
8707 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key | |
8708 combinations cannot be mapped. | |
8709 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu | |
10 | 8710 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other |
7 | 8711 keys can be mapped. |
8712 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT | |
8713 key is never used for the menu. | |
36 | 8714 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will |
8715 select the menu, unless it has been mapped. | |
7 | 8716 |
16778
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8717 *'wincolor'* *'wcr'* |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8718 'wincolor' 'wcr' string (default empty) |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8719 local to window |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8720 Highlight group name to use for this window instead of the Normal |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8721 color |hl-Normal|. |
eda4d65f232c
patch 8.1.1391: no popup window support
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
parents:
16740
diff
changeset
|
8722 |
164 | 8723 *'window'* *'wi'* |
8724 'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1) | |
8725 global | |
8726 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window, | |
8727 use 'lines' for that. | |
179 | 8728 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the |
8729 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll | |
8730 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one. | |
164 | 8731 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll |
8732 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines. | |
8733 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than | |
8734 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1. | |
8735 | |
7 | 8736 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591* |
8737 'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1) | |
8738 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8739 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8740 feature} |
8741 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard | |
10 | 8742 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the |
1621 | 8743 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the |
8744 cost of the height of other windows. | |
8745 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing. | |
8746 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen. | |
8747 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback | |
8748 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4" | |
8749 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done, | |
8750 using the |VimEnter| event: > | |
8751 au VimEnter * set winheight=999 | |
8752 < Minimum value is 1. | |
8753 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the | |
7 | 8754 height of the current window. |
8755 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set | |
8756 the minimal height for other windows. | |
8757 | |
8758 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'* | |
8759 'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off) | |
8760 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8761 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8762 feature} |
8763 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and | |
1152 | 8764 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the |
8765 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|. | |
7 | 8766 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room. |
8767 | |
782 | 8768 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'* |
8769 'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off) | |
8770 local to window | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8771 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
782 | 8772 feature} |
8773 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and | |
1152 | 8774 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. |
782 | 8775 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room. |
8776 | |
7 | 8777 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'* |
8778 'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1) | |
8779 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8780 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| |
7 | 8781 feature} |
8782 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window. | |
8783 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller. | |
8784 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a | |
8785 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when | |
8786 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.) | |
8787 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window. | |
8788 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a | |
8789 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few | |
8790 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable. | |
8791 | |
8792 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'* | |
8793 'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1) | |
8794 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8795 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 8796 feature} |
8797 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window. | |
8798 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller. | |
8799 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just | |
8800 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one | |
8801 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere | |
8802 to go.) | |
8803 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window. | |
8804 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a | |
8805 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few | |
8806 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable. | |
8807 | |
12138
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8808 *'winptydll'* |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8809 'winptydll' string (default "winpty32.dll" or "winpty64.dll") |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8810 global |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8811 {only available when compiled with the |terminal| |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8812 feature on MS-Windows} |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8813 Specifies the name of the winpty shared library, used for the |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8814 |:terminal| command. The default depends on whether was build as a |
12254 | 8815 32-bit or 64-bit executable. If not found, "winpty.dll" is tried as |
12138
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8816 a fallback. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8817 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8818 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8819 security reasons. |
bee3751f3d4e
patch 8.0.0949: winpty.dll name is fixed
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
11914
diff
changeset
|
8820 |
7 | 8821 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592* |
8822 'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20) | |
8823 global | |
2570
71b56b4e7785
Make the references to features in the help more consistent. (Sylvain Hitier)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents:
2561
diff
changeset
|
8824 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit| |
7 | 8825 feature} |
8826 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard | |
8827 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If | |
8828 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of | |
8829 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window | |
8830 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing. | |
8831 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the | |
8832 width of the current window. | |
8833 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set | |
8834 the minimal width for other windows. | |
8835 | |
8836 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'* | |
8837 'wrap' boolean (default on) | |
8838 local to window | |
8839 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text | |
8840 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that. | |
8841 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and | |
10 | 8842 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap |
8843 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is | |
7 | 8844 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll |
8845 horizontally. | |
8846 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See | |
8847 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary. | |
8848 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: > | |
8849 :set sidescroll=5 | |
8850 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:> | |
8851 < See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|. | |
2033
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8852 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is |
de5a43c5eedc
Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents:
1904
diff
changeset
|
8853 on. |
7 | 8854 |
8855 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'* | |
8856 'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0) | |
8857 local to buffer | |
8858 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping | |
8859 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted | |
8860 and inserting continues on the next line. | |
8861 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause | |
8862 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible. | |
8863 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used. | |
7147
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
8864 This option is set to 0 when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' |
c590de398af9
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/ca63501fbcd1cf9c8aa9ff12c093c95b62a89ed7
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
7080
diff
changeset
|
8865 is reset. |
16610 | 8866 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. |
7 | 8867 |
8868 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'* | |
8869 'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385* | |
8870 global | |
500 | 8871 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and |
8872 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes. | |
7 | 8873 |
8874 *'write'* *'nowrite'* | |
8875 'write' boolean (default on) | |
8876 global | |
8877 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed. | |
8878 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are | |
10 | 8879 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line |
7 | 8880 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires |
8881 writing a temporary file. | |
8882 | |
8883 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'* | |
8884 'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off) | |
8885 global | |
8886 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override. | |
8887 | |
8888 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'* | |
8889 'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off | |
8890 otherwise) | |
8891 global | |
8892 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after | |
8893 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is | |
3513 | 8894 also on. |
8895 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write | |
8896 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you | |
8897 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset | |
8898 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write | |
8899 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful). | |
8900 See |backup-table| for another explanation. | |
7 | 8901 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway. |
8902 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is | |
8903 set. | |
8904 | |
8905 *'writedelay'* *'wd'* | |
8906 'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0) | |
8907 global | |
9344
33c1b85d408c
commit https://github.com/vim/vim/commit/802a0d902fca423acb15f835d7b09183883d79a0
Christian Brabandt <cb@256bit.org>
parents:
9286
diff
changeset
|
8908 The number of milliseconds to wait for each character sent to the |
7 | 8909 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by |
8910 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes. | |
8911 | |
14421 | 8912 vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:norl: |